install: Add glibc to the global profile.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
CommitLineData
568717fd
LC
1\input texinfo
2@c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4@c %**start of header
5@setfilename guix.info
6@documentencoding UTF-8
f8348b91 7@settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
568717fd
LC
8@c %**end of header
9
10@include version.texi
7df7a74e
NK
11
12@copying
db5a9444 13Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
af8a56b8 14Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014 Andreas Enge@*
87eafdbd 15Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
8c01b9d0
ML
16Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Mathieu Lirzin@*
17Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
97d76250
LF
18Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
19Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari
7df7a74e
NK
20
21Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
22under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
23any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
24Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
25copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
26Documentation License''.
27@end copying
568717fd 28
eeaf4427 29@dircategory Package management
568717fd
LC
30@direntry
31* guix: (guix). Guix, the functional package manager.
e49951eb 32* guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package
eeaf4427 33 Managing packages with Guix.
e49951eb 34* guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build
568717fd 35 Building packages with Guix.
054e8576
LC
36* guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system
37 Managing the operating system configuration.
568717fd 38@end direntry
568717fd 39
372c4bbc
DT
40@dircategory Software development
41@direntry
42* guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment
43 Building development environments with Guix.
44@end direntry
45
568717fd 46@titlepage
7730d112
LC
47@title GNU Guix Reference Manual
48@subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
2cbed07e 49@author The GNU Guix Developers
568717fd
LC
50
51@page
52@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
53Edition @value{EDITION} @*
54@value{UPDATED} @*
55
7df7a74e 56@insertcopying
568717fd
LC
57@end titlepage
58
568717fd
LC
59@contents
60
61@c *********************************************************************
62@node Top
f8348b91 63@top GNU Guix
568717fd 64
f8348b91
LC
65This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
66package management tool written for the GNU system.
568717fd
LC
67
68@menu
69* Introduction:: What is Guix about?
bd5e766b 70* Installation:: Installing Guix.
eeaf4427 71* Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
c554de89 72* Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
568717fd
LC
73* Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
74* Utilities:: Package management commands.
a1ba8475 75* GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
9bf3c1a7 76* Contributing:: Your help needed!
568717fd
LC
77
78* Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
79* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
80* Concept Index:: Concepts.
a85b83d2 81* Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
aaa3eaa9
LC
82
83@detailmenu
84 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
85
86Installation
87
1b2b8177 88* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
aaa3eaa9 89* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 90* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
aaa3eaa9
LC
91* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
92* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 93* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
aaa3eaa9
LC
94
95Setting Up the Daemon
96
97* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
98* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
99
100Package Management
101
102* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
103* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
aaa3eaa9
LC
104* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
105* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
106* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
107* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
108* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
109
c554de89
AK
110Emacs Interface
111
112* Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
113* Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
687c9bc0 114* Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
9b0afb0d 115* Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
c554de89 116* Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
34850cd5 117* Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
187f80c6
AK
118* Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
119* Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
32950fc8 120* Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
c554de89 121
aaa3eaa9
LC
122Programming Interface
123
124* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
125* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
126* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
127* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
128* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
129* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
130
92492b23
LC
131Defining Packages
132
133* package Reference:: The package data type.
134* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
135
aaa3eaa9
LC
136Utilities
137
138* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
fcc58db6 139* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
aaa3eaa9
LC
140* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
141* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
142* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
143* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
144* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 145* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 146* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
aaa3eaa9 147* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 148* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 149* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 150* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
aaa3eaa9
LC
151
152GNU Distribution
153
154* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 155* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
aaa3eaa9
LC
156* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
157* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
158* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
159* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
160* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
161* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
162
163System Configuration
164
165* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
166* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
167* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
168* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
169* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 170* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
aaa3eaa9
LC
171* Services:: Specifying system services.
172* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
1b2b8177 173* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 174* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
aaa3eaa9
LC
175* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
176* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
177* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 178* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
aaa3eaa9
LC
179* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
180
181Services
182
183* Base Services:: Essential system services.
184* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
185* X Window:: Graphical display.
1b2b8177
LC
186* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
187* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 188* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
cbd02397 189* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 190* Various Services:: Other services.
aaa3eaa9 191
0adfe95a
LC
192Defining Services
193
194* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
195* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
196* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 197* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a 198
aaa3eaa9
LC
199Packaging Guidelines
200
ec0339cd
LC
201* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
202* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
203* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 204* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
205* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
206* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
207* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
aaa3eaa9 208
8c01b9d0
ML
209Contributing
210
211* Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
212* Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
213* The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
214* Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
215* Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
216
217Coding Style
218
219* Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
220* Modules:: Where to store your code?
221* Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
222* Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
223
aaa3eaa9 224@end detailmenu
568717fd
LC
225@end menu
226
227@c *********************************************************************
228@node Introduction
229@chapter Introduction
230
c80e7e55
LC
231GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
232using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a functional
233package management tool for the GNU system. Package management consists
4bfc4ea3
NK
234of all activities that relate to building packages from sources,
235honoring their build-time and run-time dependencies,
c80e7e55
LC
236installing packages in user environments, upgrading installed packages
237to new versions or rolling back to a previous set, removing unused
238software packages, etc.
568717fd
LC
239
240@cindex functional package management
241The term @dfn{functional} refers to a specific package management
136787cb
LC
242discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
243In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
4bfc4ea3
NK
244as a function, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
245such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
246returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
568717fd
LC
247solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
248scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
4bfc4ea3
NK
249always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
250cannot alter the system's environment in
568717fd
LC
251any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
252of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
e900c503 253build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
4bfc4ea3 254explicit inputs are visible.
568717fd 255
e531ac2a 256@cindex store
568717fd 257The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
e531ac2a
LC
258system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
259Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own, in the
834129e0 260store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
568717fd
LC
261a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
262input yields a different directory name.
263
264This approach is the foundation of Guix's salient features: support for
4bfc4ea3 265transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
eeaf4427 266garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
568717fd 267
4bfc4ea3 268Guix has a command-line interface, which allows users to build, install,
568717fd 269upgrade, and remove packages, as well as a Scheme programming interface.
568717fd 270
3ca2731c 271@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 272@cindex GuixSD
a1ba8475 273Last but not least, Guix is used to build a distribution of the GNU
3ca2731c 274system, with many GNU and non-GNU free software packages. The Guix
4705641f
LC
275System Distribution, or GNU@tie{}GuixSD, takes advantage of the core
276properties of Guix at the system level. With GuixSD, users
3ca2731c
LC
277@emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system configuration, and
278Guix takes care of instantiating that configuration in a reproducible,
279stateless fashion. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
a1ba8475 280
bd5e766b
LC
281@c *********************************************************************
282@node Installation
283@chapter Installation
284
48febeb8
LC
285GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
286@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
287software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
288ready to use it.
bd5e766b 289
5af6de3e
LC
290Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
291manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
292instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
6621cdb6 293@pxref{System Installation}.
5af6de3e 294
bd5e766b 295@menu
09722b11 296* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
bd5e766b 297* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 298* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
bd5e766b
LC
299* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
300* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 301* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
bd5e766b
LC
302@end menu
303
09722b11
LC
304@node Binary Installation
305@section Binary Installation
306
307This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
308self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
309dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
310is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
311GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
312
313Installing goes along these lines:
314
315@enumerate
316@item
317Download the binary tarball from
daa8922a
LC
318@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
319where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
320already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
321
322Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
323authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
324
325@example
326$ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
327$ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
328@end example
329
330If that command fails because you don't have the required public key,
331then run this command to import it:
332
333@example
334$ gpg --keyserver keys.gnupg.net --recv-keys 3D9AEBB5
335@end example
336
337@noindent
338and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
09722b11
LC
339
340@item
341As @code{root}, run:
342
343@example
5dc42964 344# cd /tmp
254b1c2e
LC
345# tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
346 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
5dc42964 347# mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
09722b11
LC
348@end example
349
7acd3439
LC
350This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
351The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
352step.)
09722b11 353
5dc3ce5f
LC
354Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
355would overwrite its own essential files.
356
254b1c2e 357The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
e9ba6357
LC
358not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
359warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
360versions are fine.)
361They stem from the fact that all the
254b1c2e
LC
362files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
363means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
364archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
365reproducible.
366
7acd3439
LC
367@item
368Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
369
370@example
371# ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
372 ~root/.guix-profile
373@end example
374
43c33047
LC
375@item
376Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
377(@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
378
09722b11 379@item
175ced41 380Run the daemon:
09722b11
LC
381
382@example
7acd3439 383# ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
09722b11
LC
384@end example
385
d2825c96
LC
386On hosts using the systemd init system, drop
387@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service} in
388@file{/etc/systemd/system}.
389
ad227484
MDRS
390Likewise, on hosts using the Upstart init system, drop
391@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf} in
392@file{/etc/init}.
393
09722b11
LC
394@item
395Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
396for instance with:
397
398@example
399# mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
400# cd /usr/local/bin
d72d05f9 401# ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
09722b11 402@end example
39f8ed14 403
aca738f3
LC
404It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
405there:
406
407@example
408# mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
409# cd /usr/local/share/info
410# for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
411 do ln -s $i ; done
412@end example
413
414That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
415running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
416Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
417Info search path.)
418
39f8ed14
LC
419@item
420To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}),
421authorize them:
422
423@example
7acd3439 424# guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
39f8ed14 425@end example
09722b11
LC
426@end enumerate
427
53de532f
LC
428And that's it! For additional tips and tricks, @pxref{Application
429Setup}.
09722b11 430
5dc3ce5f 431The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s
09722b11
LC
432profile, or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which
433case you would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the
434@command{guix} command.
435
39f8ed14
LC
436The tarball in question can be (re)produced and verified simply by
437running the following command in the Guix source tree:
09722b11
LC
438
439@example
440make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
441@end example
442
443
bd5e766b
LC
444@node Requirements
445@section Requirements
446
09722b11
LC
447This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
448build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
449not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
450in the Guix source tree for additional details.
451
bd5e766b
LC
452GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
453
454@itemize
47c66da0 455@item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
288dca55 456@item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
f0b98b84 457@item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
8a96bd4b
ID
458@end itemize
459
460The following dependencies are optional:
461
462@itemize
288dca55 463@item
8a96bd4b 464Installing
288dca55 465@url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
2f7d2d91
LC
466allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
467guix import}). It is of
288dca55 468interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
8a96bd4b
ID
469@item
470Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will
471allow you to access @code{https} URLs with the @command{guix download}
d45dc6da
EB
472command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the @command{guix import pypi}
473command, and the @command{guix import cpan} command. This is primarily
474of interest to developers. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the
475GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
bd5e766b
LC
476@end itemize
477
478Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
479following packages are also needed:
480
481@itemize
368d08f7
LC
482@item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
483@item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
484@item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
485C++11 standard.
bd5e766b
LC
486@end itemize
487
4bfc4ea3
NK
488When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
489manager} is available, you
bd5e766b 490can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
4bfc4ea3 491Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
bd5e766b 492
b22a12fd
LC
493Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
494between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
495same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
4bfc4ea3
NK
496@code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
497specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
834129e0 498located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
b22a12fd 499@code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
4bfc4ea3
NK
500Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
501your goal is to share the store with Nix.
b22a12fd 502
ec0339cd
LC
503@node Running the Test Suite
504@section Running the Test Suite
505
506After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
507idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
508environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
509failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
510suite, type:
511
512@example
513make check
514@end example
515
516Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
517GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
518on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
519that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
520cache.
521
a887fd8d
LC
522It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
523@code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
524
525@example
526make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
527@end example
528
ec0339cd
LC
529Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
530@file{test-suite.log} file. When @file{tests/@var{something}.scm}
531fails, please also attach the @file{@var{something}.log} file available
532in the top-level build directory. Please specify the Guix version being
533used as well as version numbers of the dependencies
534(@pxref{Requirements}) in your message.
535
bd5e766b
LC
536@node Setting Up the Daemon
537@section Setting Up the Daemon
538
539@cindex daemon
540Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
49e6291a 541are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
bd5e766b
LC
542behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
543associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
544goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
e49951eb 545@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
bd5e766b
LC
546daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
547
49e6291a 548The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
225dafde
LC
549environment. Also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
550the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
49e6291a
LC
551
552@menu
553* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
554* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
555@end menu
556
557@node Build Environment Setup
558@subsection Build Environment Setup
559
bd5e766b
LC
560In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
561@command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
834129e0 562administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
bd5e766b
LC
563@command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
564Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
565daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
566consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
567
568@cindex build users
569When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
570build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
571security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
572should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
573These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
574just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
575processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
576distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
577do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
578regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
579
580On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
581Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
582
091196b3
LC
583@c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
584@c for why `-G' is needed.
bd5e766b 585@example
cfc149dc
LC
586# groupadd --system guixbuild
587# for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
bd5e766b 588 do
cfc149dc
LC
589 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
590 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
591 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
592 guixbuilder$i;
bd5e766b
LC
593 done
594@end example
595
596@noindent
54eb03ab
LC
597The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
598parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
d2825c96
LC
599(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). The
600@code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
601following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
602dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
603file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
ad227484
MDRS
604@command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
605machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
606@file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
607file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
bd5e766b
LC
608
609@example
cfc149dc 610# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
611@end example
612
e900c503 613@cindex chroot
b095792f
LC
614@noindent
615This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
cfc149dc 616the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
6dc99317
LC
617environment contains nothing but:
618
619@c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
620@itemize
621@item
4743a4da
LC
622a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
623host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
624that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
625can only be created if the host has them.};
626
627@item
628the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the container's processes
629since a separate PID name space is used;
6dc99317
LC
630
631@item
632@file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
633user @file{nobody};
634
635@item
636@file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
637
638@item
639@file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
640@code{127.0.0.1};
641
642@item
643a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
644@end itemize
b095792f 645
cb960102
ED
646You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
647@i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
7a57c96a 648within the chroot is always @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
cb960102
ED
649where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
650This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
651environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
652capture the name of their build tree.
653
e0c941fe
LC
654@vindex http_proxy
655The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
656HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
657(@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
658
1e2644bb
LC
659If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
660to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
661However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
662from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
663each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
664available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
665@emph{pure} functions.
bd5e766b 666
49e6291a
LC
667
668@node Daemon Offload Setup
669@subsection Using the Offload Facility
670
671@cindex offloading
4ec2e92d
LC
672@cindex build hook
673When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload}
674derivation builds to other machines
49e6291a
LC
675running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build hook}. When that
676feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
677@file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; anytime a build is requested, for
678instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
679of the machines that satisfies the derivation's constraints, in
680particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
681prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
682which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
683build are copied back to the initial machine.
684
4ec2e92d 685The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
49e6291a
LC
686
687@example
688(list (build-machine
689 (name "eightysix.example.org")
690 (system "x86_64-linux")
691 (user "bob")
692 (speed 2.)) ; incredibly fast!
693
694 (build-machine
695 (name "meeps.example.org")
696 (system "mips64el-linux")
697 (user "alice")
698 (private-key
699 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
c4fdfd6f 700 "/.lsh/identity-for-guix"))))
49e6291a
LC
701@end example
702
703@noindent
704In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
705the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
4ec2e92d
LC
706architecture.
707
708In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
709evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
710must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
711shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
712DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
713local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
c678a4ee
LC
714Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
715detailed below.
4ec2e92d 716
c678a4ee
LC
717@deftp {Data Type} build-machine
718This data type represents build machines the daemon may offload builds
719to. The important fields are:
49e6291a
LC
720
721@table @code
722
723@item name
724The remote machine's host name.
725
726@item system
c678a4ee 727The remote machine's system type---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
49e6291a
LC
728
729@item user
730The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
731Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
732allow non-interactive logins.
733
734@end table
735
4ec2e92d 736A number of optional fields may be specified:
49e6291a
LC
737
738@table @code
739
cecd72d5
LC
740@item port
741Port number of the machine's SSH server (default: 22).
742
49e6291a
LC
743@item private-key
744The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine.
745
c4fdfd6f
LC
746Currently offloading uses GNU@tie{}lsh as its SSH client
747(@pxref{Invoking lsh,,, GNU lsh Manual}). Thus, the key file here must
748be an lsh key file. This may change in the future, though.
749
49e6291a
LC
750@item parallel-builds
751The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine (1 by
752default.)
753
754@item speed
755A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
756machines with a higher speed factor.
757
758@item features
759A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
760An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
761and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
762name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
763
764@end table
c678a4ee 765@end deftp
49e6291a
LC
766
767The @code{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
768machines, since offloading works by invoking the @code{guix archive} and
c4fdfd6f
LC
769@code{guix build} commands. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
770@code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
771this is the case by running:
772
773@example
74273b6f 774lsh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
c4fdfd6f 775@end example
49e6291a
LC
776
777There's one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
778explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
c4fdfd6f
LC
779between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
780generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
781archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
49e6291a
LC
782
783@example
784# guix archive --generate-key
785@end example
786
787@noindent
c4fdfd6f
LC
788Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
789it accepts store items it receives from the master:
790
791@example
792# guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
793@end example
794
795@noindent
796Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
797
798All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
799relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
800the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
801build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
802with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
49e6291a
LC
803
804
bd5e766b
LC
805@node Invoking guix-daemon
806@section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
807
808The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
809access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
810garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
811is normally run as @code{root} like this:
812
813@example
cfc149dc 814# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
815@end example
816
817@noindent
081145cf 818For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
bd5e766b 819
e900c503
LC
820@cindex chroot
821@cindex container, build environment
822@cindex build environment
823@cindex reproducible builds
bd5e766b
LC
824By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
825different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
826@code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
827chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
828build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
829(@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
830system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
e900c503
LC
831@file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
832@dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
833a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
834etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
bd5e766b 835
cbc538fe
LC
836When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
837build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
838its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
839the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
840directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
841with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
842sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
843it would otherwise not hit.
844
845The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
846build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
847(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
848
bd5e766b
LC
849The following command-line options are supported:
850
851@table @code
852@item --build-users-group=@var{group}
853Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
854the Daemon, build users}).
855
6858f9d1 856@item --no-substitutes
b5385b52 857@cindex substitutes
6858f9d1 858Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
c4202d60
LC
859locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
860(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6858f9d1 861
b5385b52
LC
862By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
863@command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
864@code{--no-substitutes}.
865
866When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
867explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
868remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
869
9176607e 870@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
f8a8e0fe 871@anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
9176607e 872Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
ae806096 873source URLs. When this option is omitted, @indicateurl{http://hydra.gnu.org}
9176607e
LC
874is used.
875
876This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
877as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
878
4ec2e92d
LC
879@cindex build hook
880@item --no-build-hook
881Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
882
883The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
884which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
885builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
886
bd5e766b
LC
887@item --cache-failures
888Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
889
30d9aa54
LC
890When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
891to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
892--clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
893@xref{Invoking guix gc}.
894
bd5e766b
LC
895@item --cores=@var{n}
896@itemx -c @var{n}
897Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
898as available.
899
6efc160e 900The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
e49951eb
MW
901as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
902guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
903
904The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
905in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
906parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
907
908@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
909@itemx -M @var{n}
910Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
f6526eb3
LC
911@code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
912locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
913Setup}), or simply fail.
bd5e766b 914
ecf84b7c
LC
915@item --rounds=@var{N}
916Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
917consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
918setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
919(@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
920
bd5e766b
LC
921@item --debug
922Produce debugging output.
923
924This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
925overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
e49951eb 926@command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
927
928@item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
929Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
930
931Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
932they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
933and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
934Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
935needs.
936
937@item --disable-chroot
938Disable chroot builds.
939
940Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1e2644bb
LC
941processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
942though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
943account.
bd5e766b
LC
944
945@item --disable-log-compression
946Disable compression of the build logs.
947
1da983b9
LC
948Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
949@var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
950them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
951
ab3893d7
LC
952@item --disable-deduplication
953@cindex deduplication
bd5e766b
LC
954Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
955
1da983b9 956By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
ab3893d7
LC
957if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
958the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
4988dd40 959noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
ab3893d7
LC
960input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
961this optimization.
1da983b9 962
6e37066e
LC
963@item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
964Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
965derivations.
966
967When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
968available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
969meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
970
971@item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
972Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
973corresponding to live outputs.
974
975When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
976derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
977outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
978items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
979
980Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
981@code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
982prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
983tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
984prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
985saves rebuilds or downloads.
986
bd5e766b
LC
987@item --impersonate-linux-2.6
988On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
989kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
990
991This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
992on the kernel version number.
993
994@item --lose-logs
995Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
ce33631f 996@code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
bd5e766b
LC
997
998@item --system=@var{system}
999Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1000architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1001@code{x86_64-linux}.
b8d2aa26
LC
1002
1003@item --listen=@var{socket}
1004Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1005socket. The default socket is
1006@file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1007useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1008daemons on the same machine.
bd5e766b
LC
1009@end table
1010
1011
0e2d0213
LC
1012@node Application Setup
1013@section Application Setup
1014
85e57214
LC
1015When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1016so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1017get everything in place. Here are some of them.
0e2d0213
LC
1018
1019@subsection Locales
1020
5c3c1427 1021@anchor{locales-and-locpath}
0e2d0213 1022@cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
5c3c1427 1023@vindex LOCPATH
85e57214 1024@vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
0e2d0213
LC
1025Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the host system's locale
1026data. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
85e57214
LC
1027available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1028variable:
0e2d0213
LC
1029
1030@example
1031$ guix package -i glibc-locales
85e57214 1032$ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
0e2d0213
LC
1033@end example
1034
1035Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1036locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1037110@tie{}MiB. Alternately, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1038limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1039
85e57214
LC
1040The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1041(@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1042Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1043
1044@enumerate
1045@item
1046@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by Guix's libc, and not by the libc
1047provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
f9b9a033 1048to make sure the foreign distro's programs will not end up loading
85e57214
LC
1049incompatible locale data.
1050
1051@item
1052libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1053@code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1054should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1055different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1056data in the right format.
1057@end enumerate
1058
1059This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1060versions may be incompatible.
1061
0e2d0213
LC
1062@subsection X11 Fonts
1063
4988dd40 1064The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
0e2d0213
LC
1065load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. Guix's
1066@code{fontconfig} package looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1067by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1068to display fonts, you will have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1069Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
8fe5b1d1 1070@code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
0e2d0213 1071
5c36edc8
LC
1072To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1073graphical applications, consider installing
1074@code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1075has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1076Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1077for Chinese languages:
1078
1079@example
1080guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1081@end example
1082
6d97319c
AK
1083@subsection Emacs Packages
1084
1085When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1086either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1087sub-directories of
1088@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1089directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1090packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1091reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1092directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1093the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1094Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1095
1096By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1097are placed, so you don't need to perform any configuration. If, for
1098some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1099with Guix, you can do it by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1100option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1101
0e2d0213
LC
1102@c TODO What else?
1103
eeaf4427
LC
1104@c *********************************************************************
1105@node Package Management
1106@chapter Package Management
1107
f8348b91 1108The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
eeaf4427
LC
1109remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1110procedure or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1111features.
1112
1113This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
c1941588 1114management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
c554de89
AK
1115routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1116(@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1117interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
eeaf4427
LC
1118
1119@menu
1120* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
e49951eb 1121* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
c4202d60 1122* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
760c60d6 1123* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
e49951eb 1124* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
f651b477 1125* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
760c60d6 1126* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
eeaf4427
LC
1127@end menu
1128
1129@node Features
1130@section Features
1131
1132When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1133own directory---something that resembles
9a130e19
AK
1134@file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1135(note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
081145cf 1136names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
eeaf4427
LC
1137
1138Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1139@dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
821b0015
LC
1140use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1141@code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
eeaf4427 1142
821b0015 1143For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
eeaf4427 1144@file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
834129e0 1145@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
821b0015
LC
1146@code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1147simply continues to point to
834129e0 1148@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
821b0015 1149coexist on the same system without any interference.
eeaf4427 1150
e49951eb
MW
1151The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1152packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on those per-user
821b0015 1153profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
eeaf4427
LC
1154
1155The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1156operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
ba55b1cb 1157the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
e49951eb 1158@command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
eeaf4427
LC
1159or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1160profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1161
1162In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1163for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1164out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
4af2447e
LC
1165of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1166system configuration is subject to transactional upgrades and roll-back
1167(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
eeaf4427
LC
1168
1169All those packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1170Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by the user
fe8ff028 1171profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
e49951eb 1172(@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
fe8ff028
LC
1173generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1174collected.
eeaf4427 1175
e900c503
LC
1176@cindex reproducibility
1177@cindex reproducible builds
eeaf4427
LC
1178Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1179management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
834129e0 1180Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
eeaf4427
LC
1181inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1182scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1183given package installation matches the current state of their
e900c503
LC
1184distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1185thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1186is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1187machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
eeaf4427 1188
c4202d60 1189@cindex substitutes
eeaf4427 1190This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
c4202d60 1191deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
18f2887b 1192available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
c4202d60
LC
1193downloads it and unpacks it;
1194otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1195(@pxref{Substitutes}).
eeaf4427 1196
f5fd4fd2
LC
1197Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1198developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1199a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1200package, without having to manually install the package's dependencies
1201in their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1202
e49951eb
MW
1203@node Invoking guix package
1204@section Invoking @command{guix package}
eeaf4427 1205
e49951eb 1206The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
eeaf4427
LC
1207install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1208previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1209and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1210is:
1211
1212@example
e49951eb 1213guix package @var{options}
eeaf4427
LC
1214@end example
1215
ba55b1cb 1216Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
eeaf4427 1217the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
99bd74d5 1218previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
eeaf4427
LC
1219want to roll back.
1220
6447738c
MW
1221For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1222@code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1223
1224@example
1225guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1226@end example
1227
99bd74d5
LC
1228@command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1229whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1230passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1231(@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1232
b9e5c0a9 1233For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
0ec1af59 1234created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
b9e5c0a9
LC
1235current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1236@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1237variable, and so on.
d664f1b4
LC
1238@cindex search paths
1239If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1240following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1241Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1242shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1243
1244@example
1245GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1246source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1247@end example
b9e5c0a9 1248
4379c35b
LC
1249In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1250a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1251to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
0ec1af59
LC
1252@code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1253@var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
4379c35b
LC
1254@code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1255@file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1256started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1257package}.
0ec1af59
LC
1258
1259The @var{options} can be among the following:
1260
eeaf4427
LC
1261@table @code
1262
6447738c
MW
1263@item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1264@itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1265Install the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1266
6447738c 1267Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
eeaf4427 1268@code{guile}, or a package name followed by a hyphen and version number,
724311a2
LC
1269such as @code{guile-1.8.8} or simply @code{guile-1.8} (in the latter
1270case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1271
1272If no version number is specified, the
dc5669cd
MW
1273newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1274may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
6e721c4d 1275package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils-2.22:lib}
e7f34eb0
LC
1276(@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1277name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1278distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
eeaf4427 1279
461572cc
LC
1280@cindex propagated inputs
1281Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
21461f27
LC
1282that automatically get installed along with the required package
1283(@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1284@code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1285package definitions).
461572cc 1286
21461f27 1287@anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
461572cc
LC
1288An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1289the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1290Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1291in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1292also been explicitly installed independently.
1293
ba7ea5ce 1294Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
5924080d 1295variables for their search paths (see explanation of
ba7ea5ce 1296@code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
5924080d
LC
1297environment variable definitions are reported here.
1298
ef010c0f 1299@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
5924080d 1300Finally, when installing a GNU package, the tool reports the
ef010c0f
LC
1301availability of a newer upstream version. In the future, it may provide
1302the option of installing directly from the upstream version, even if
1303that version is not yet in the distribution.
1304
5d4b411f
LC
1305@item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1306@itemx -e @var{exp}
1307Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1308
1309@var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1310@code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1311between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1312@code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1313
1314Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1315package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1316multiple-output package.
1317
0d279400
DT
1318@item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1319@itemx -f @var{file}
1320Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1321
1322As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1323(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1324
1325@example
1326@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1327@end example
1328
1329Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{package.scm} file
1330in the root of their project's source tree that can be used to test
1331development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1332(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1333
6447738c
MW
1334@item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1335@itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1336Remove the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1337
6447738c 1338As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
13ed095c
LC
1339and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1340@code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1341@code{glibc}.
1342
6447738c
MW
1343@item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1344@itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1345Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1346specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
d5f01e48 1347@var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
eeaf4427 1348
f651b477
LC
1349Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1350in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1351you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1352pull}).
1353
d5f01e48
MW
1354@item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1355When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1356upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1357upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1358substring ``emacs'':
1359
1360@example
1361$ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1362@end example
1363
99bd74d5 1364@item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1b676447 1365@itemx -m @var{file}
99bd74d5
LC
1366@cindex profile declaration
1367@cindex profile manifest
1368Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1b676447
DT
1369returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1370
99bd74d5
LC
1371This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1372constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1373commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1374control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1375so on.
1376
1377@c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1378@var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1379of packages:
1b676447 1380
99bd74d5 1381@findex packages->manifest
1b676447 1382@example
99bd74d5 1383(use-package-modules guile emacs)
1b676447
DT
1384
1385(packages->manifest
99bd74d5
LC
1386 (list emacs
1387 guile-2.0
1b676447 1388 ;; Use a specific package output.
99bd74d5 1389 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1b676447
DT
1390@end example
1391
24e262f0
LC
1392@item --roll-back
1393Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1394the last transaction.
1395
1396When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1397before any other actions.
1398
d9307267 1399When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
4b2bc804
NK
1400installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1401generation}, which contains no files apart from its own meta-data.
d9307267 1402
82fe08ed
LC
1403Installing, removing, or upgrading packages from a generation that has
1404been rolled back to overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the
1405history of a profile's generations is always linear.
1406
b3bb82f1
AK
1407@item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1408@itemx -S @var{pattern}
1409Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1410
1411@var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1412with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1413specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1414the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1415@code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1416
1417The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1418@code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1419not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1420exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1421
dbc31ab2 1422@item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
5924080d
LC
1423@cindex search paths
1424Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1425needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1426variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1427of the installed packages.
1428
1429For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1430environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1431libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1432Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1433library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1434suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1435@code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1436
dbc31ab2
LC
1437The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1438shell:
1439
1440@example
1441$ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1442@end example
1443
1444@var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1445meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1446be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1447variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1448
fc2d2339
LC
1449This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1450of several profiles. Consider this example:
1451
1452@example
1453$ guix package -p foo -i guile
1454$ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1455$ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1456@end example
1457
1458The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1459variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1460@file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1461
1462
eeaf4427
LC
1463@item --profile=@var{profile}
1464@itemx -p @var{profile}
1465Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1466
70915c1a
LC
1467@item --verbose
1468Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the environment's build log
1469on the standard error port.
1470
eeaf4427
LC
1471@item --bootstrap
1472Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1473useful to distribution developers.
1474
1475@end table
1476
e49951eb 1477In addition to these actions @command{guix package} supports the
733b4130
LC
1478following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1479availability of packages:
eeaf4427 1480
733b4130
LC
1481@table @option
1482
acc08466
NK
1483@item --search=@var{regexp}
1484@itemx -s @var{regexp}
b110869d 1485@cindex searching for packages
5763ad92 1486List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
299112d3
LC
1487@var{regexp}. Print all the meta-data of matching packages in
1488@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1489GNU recutils manual}).
acc08466 1490
299112d3
LC
1491This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1492command, for instance:
1493
1494@example
e49951eb 1495$ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
299112d3
LC
1496name: glibc
1497version: 2.17
1498
1499name: libgc
1500version: 7.2alpha6
1501@end example
acc08466 1502
a12d92f5
LC
1503Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1504terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1505
1506@example
1507$ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1508name: elfutils
1509
1510name: gmp
1511@dots{}
1512@end example
1513
db5a9444
LC
1514It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1515flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1516games:
1517
1518@example
1519$ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1520name: gnubg
1521@dots{}
1522@end example
1523
1524If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1525that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1526around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1527keyboards.
1528
b110869d
LC
1529And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1530for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1531libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1532
1533@example
1534$ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1535 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1536@end example
1537
1538@noindent
1539@xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1540information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1541
2aa6efb0
CR
1542@item --show=@var{package}
1543Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1544@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1545recutils manual}).
1546
1547@example
1548$ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1549name: python
1550version: 2.7.6
1551
1552name: python
1553version: 3.3.5
1554@end example
1555
1556You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1557specific version of it:
1558@example
1559$ guix package --show=python-3.3.5 | recsel -p name,version
1560name: python
1561version: 3.3.5
1562@end example
1563
1564
1565
733b4130
LC
1566@item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1567@itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
bd9bde1c
LC
1568List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1569most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1570specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
733b4130
LC
1571
1572For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1573tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1574is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1575@code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1576the store.
1577
64fc89b6
LC
1578@item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1579@itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
5763ad92 1580List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
a1ba8475
LC
1581(@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1582installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
64fc89b6
LC
1583
1584For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
6e721c4d
LC
1585its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1586Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
64fc89b6 1587
f566d765
LC
1588@item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1589@itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1590Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1591generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
4b2bc804
NK
1592installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1593shown.
f566d765
LC
1594
1595For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1596tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1597that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1598location of this package in the store.
1599
1600When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1601generations. Valid patterns include:
1602
1603@itemize
1604@item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1605generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1606the first one.
1607
1608And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1609specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1610
1611@item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1612specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
1613a range must be lesser than its end.
1614
1615It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1616@code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1617second one.
1618
1619@item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1620or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
d7ddb257
LC
1621duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1622that are up to 20 days old.
f566d765
LC
1623@end itemize
1624
b7884ca3
NK
1625@item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1626@itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
d7ddb257
LC
1627When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1628one.
b7884ca3
NK
1629
1630This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
d7ddb257
LC
1631When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1632@var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1633specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1634deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1635
391bdd8f
LC
1636If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1637zeroth generation is never deleted.
b7884ca3 1638
1bb9900a
LC
1639Note that deleting generations prevents roll-back to them.
1640Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1641
733b4130 1642@end table
eeaf4427 1643
70ee5642 1644Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
ccd7158d 1645processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
b8638f03
LC
1646Options}). It also support package transformation options, such as
1647@option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
1648However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
1649preserve transformation across upgrades, you should define your own
1650package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
1651(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
1652
70ee5642 1653
c4202d60
LC
1654@node Substitutes
1655@section Substitutes
1656
1657@cindex substitutes
1658@cindex pre-built binaries
1659Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1660can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1661server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1662substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1663substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1664
1665Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1666(@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1667pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1668also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1669
1670The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1671builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
32950fc8
AK
1672architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1673Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1674server). This is the
f8a8e0fe
LC
1675default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1676@option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1677(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1678or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1679(@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1680option}).
c4202d60
LC
1681
1682@cindex security
1683@cindex digital signatures
1684To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org}, you
1685must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
1686imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
1687archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
1688be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
1689
1690This public key is installed along with Guix, in
1691@code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
1692the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
1693make sure you checked the GPG signature of
1694@file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
1695Then, you can run something like this:
1696
1697@example
1698# guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
1699@end example
1700
1701Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
1702should change from something like:
1703
1704@example
1705$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1706The following derivations would be built:
1707 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
1708 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
1709 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
1710 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
1711@dots{}
1712@end example
1713
1714@noindent
1715to something like:
1716
1717@example
1718$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1719The following files would be downloaded:
1720 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
1721 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
1722 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
1723 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
1724@dots{}
1725@end example
1726
1727@noindent
1728This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
1729will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
1730
1731Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
ef27aa9c 1732one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
c4202d60
LC
1733when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
1734
e0c941fe
LC
1735@vindex http_proxy
1736Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP. The @code{http_proxy} environment
1737variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
1738honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
1739@code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
1740@command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
1741@emph{absolutely no effect}.
1742
c4202d60
LC
1743The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
1744@code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
1745guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
1746@code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
1747build}, and other command-line tools.
1748
1749
1750Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
1751mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
1752determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
1753weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
1754convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
1755their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
8ce229fc
LC
1756interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
1757build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
1758of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
c4202d60
LC
1759
1760Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
1761(@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
1762package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
1763a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
d23c20f1
LC
1764integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
1765help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
1766finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
a8d65643
LC
1767challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
1768build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
1769are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
1770@command{guix build --check}}).
c4202d60
LC
1771
1772In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
1773binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
1774like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
1775
1776
6e721c4d
LC
1777@node Packages with Multiple Outputs
1778@section Packages with Multiple Outputs
1779
1780@cindex multiple-output packages
1781@cindex package outputs
1782
1783Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
1784source package leads exactly one directory in the store. When running
1785@command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
1786GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
1787can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
1788default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
1789libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
1790files.
1791
1792Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
1793produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
1794instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
1795installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
1796To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
1797separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
1798which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
1799
1800@example
1801guix package -i glib
1802@end example
1803
1804The command to install its documentation is:
1805
1806@example
1807guix package -i glib:doc
1808@end example
1809
1810Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
1811For instance, the WordNet package install both command-line tools and
1812graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
1813library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
1814libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
1815output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
fcc58db6
LC
1816who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
1817can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
88856916 1818@command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
6e721c4d
LC
1819
1820There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
91ef73d4
LC
1821Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
1822possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
1823@code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
1824Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
1825the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
1826guix package}).
6e721c4d 1827
eeaf4427 1828
e49951eb
MW
1829@node Invoking guix gc
1830@section Invoking @command{guix gc}
fe8ff028
LC
1831
1832@cindex garbage collector
1833Packages that are installed but not used may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
e49951eb 1834The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
c22eb992
LC
1835collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
1836the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
1837files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
fe8ff028
LC
1838
1839The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
834129e0 1840@file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
fe8ff028
LC
1841cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
1842deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
e49951eb
MW
1843profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
1844example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
fe8ff028 1845
1bb9900a
LC
1846Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
1847often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
1848package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
1849is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
1850(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
1851
e49951eb 1852The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
fe8ff028 1853used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
7770aafc
LC
1854files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
1855information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
1856options are as follows:
fe8ff028
LC
1857
1858@table @code
1859@item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
1860@itemx -C [@var{min}]
834129e0 1861Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
fe8ff028
LC
1862sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
1863specified.
1864
1865When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
1866@var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4a44d7bb
LC
1867suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
1868(@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
fe8ff028
LC
1869
1870When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
1871
1872@item --delete
1873@itemx -d
1874Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
1875arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
1876they are still live.
1877
30d9aa54
LC
1878@item --list-failures
1879List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
1880
1881This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
1882@option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
1883@option{--cache-failures}}).
1884
1885@item --clear-failures
1886Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
1887
1888Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
1889@option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
1890
fe8ff028
LC
1891@item --list-dead
1892Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
1893store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
1894
1895@item --list-live
1896Show the list of live store files and directories.
ba8b732d
LC
1897
1898@end table
1899
1900In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
1901
1902@table @code
1903
1904@item --references
1905@itemx --referrers
1906List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
1907as arguments.
1908
8e59fdd5
LC
1909@item --requisites
1910@itemx -R
fcc58db6 1911@cindex closure
8e59fdd5
LC
1912List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
1913include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
1914of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
1915@dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
1916
fcc58db6 1917@xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of an
88856916
LC
1918element's closure. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
1919the graph of references.
fcc58db6 1920
fe8ff028
LC
1921@end table
1922
7770aafc
LC
1923Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
1924store and to control disk usage.
1925
1926@table @option
1927
1928@item --verify[=@var{options}]
1929@cindex integrity, of the store
1930@cindex integrity checking
1931Verify the integrity of the store.
1932
1933By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
1934daemon's database actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
1935
1936When provided, @var{options} must a comma-separated list containing one
1937or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
1938
1939When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon will compute the
1940content hash of each store item and compare it against its hash in the
1941database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
1942traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
1943long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
1944
1945@cindex repairing the store
1946Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
1947causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
1948substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
1949atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
1950system administrator.
1951
1952@item --optimize
1953@cindex deduplication
1954Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
1955@dfn{deduplication}.
1956
1957The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
1958import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
1959(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
1960this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
1961@code{--disable-deduplication}.
1962
1963@end table
eeaf4427 1964
f651b477
LC
1965@node Invoking guix pull
1966@section Invoking @command{guix pull}
1967
1968Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
1969the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
1970that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
1971pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
1972descriptions, and deploys it.
1973
1974On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
1975versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
1976the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
1977version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
ef54b61d
AV
1978become available@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates
1979the @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest
1980Guix, and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
f651b477
LC
1981
1982The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
1983but it supports the following options:
1984
1985@table @code
1986@item --verbose
1987Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
1988
ab5d72ad
LC
1989@item --url=@var{url}
1990Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
1991
1992By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
1993@code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
1994
f651b477
LC
1995@item --bootstrap
1996Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
1997useful to Guix developers.
1998@end table
1999
760c60d6
LC
2000
2001@node Invoking guix archive
2002@section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2003
2004The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2005from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2006In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2007to another machine's store. For example, to transfer the @code{emacs}
2008package to a machine connected over SSH, one would run:
2009
2010@example
56607088 2011guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
760c60d6
LC
2012@end example
2013
87236aed 2014@noindent
56607088
LC
2015Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2016to another like this:
2017
2018@example
2019guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2020 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2021@end example
2022
2023@noindent
2024However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2025profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2026@code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the target
2027machine's store. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2028items are missing from the target's store.
87236aed 2029
760c60d6 2030Archives are stored in the ``Nix archive'' or ``Nar'' format, which is
0dbd88db
LC
2031comparable in spirit to `tar', but with a few noteworthy differences
2032that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2033recording all Unix meta-data for each file, the Nar format only mentions
2034the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2035and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2036entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2037the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2038deterministic.
2039
2040When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2041and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2042verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2043signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
760c60d6
LC
2044@c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2045
2046The main options are:
2047
2048@table @code
2049@item --export
2050Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2051resulting archive to the standard output.
2052
56607088
LC
2053Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2054@code{--recursive} is passed.
2055
2056@item -r
2057@itemx --recursive
2058When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2059archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2060Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2061of the exported store items.
2062
760c60d6
LC
2063@item --import
2064Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2065therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
f82cc5fd
LC
2066signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2067keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
554f26ec 2068
87236aed
LC
2069@item --missing
2070Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2071and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2072the store.
2073
554f26ec 2074@item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
f82cc5fd 2075@cindex signing, archives
554f26ec
LC
2076Generate a new key pair for the daemons. This is a prerequisite before
2077archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2078usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2079generate the key pair.
2080
2081The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2082@file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
867d8473
LC
2083key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2084an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2085versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
2086Alternately, @var{parameters} can specify
554f26ec
LC
2087@code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2088public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2089Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
f82cc5fd
LC
2090
2091@item --authorize
2092@cindex authorizing, archives
2093Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2094The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2095same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2096
2097The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2098@file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2099@url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2100s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2101@url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2102(SPKI)}.
c6f8e9dd
LC
2103
2104@item --extract=@var{directory}
2105@itemx -x @var{directory}
2106Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2107(@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2108low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2109
2110For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2111served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2112
2113@example
2114$ wget -O - \
2115 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2116 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2117@end example
2118
2119Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2120by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2121and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2122@emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2123unsafe.
2124
2125The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2126archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2127
760c60d6
LC
2128@end table
2129
2130To export store files as an archive to the standard output, run:
2131
2132@example
2133guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2134@end example
2135
2136@var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2137specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2138package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2139containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2140output of @code{emacs}:
2141
2142@example
834129e0 2143guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
760c60d6
LC
2144@end example
2145
2146If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2147automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
ccd7158d 2148common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
760c60d6 2149
c554de89
AK
2150@c *********************************************************************
2151@include emacs.texi
760c60d6 2152
568717fd
LC
2153@c *********************************************************************
2154@node Programming Interface
2155@chapter Programming Interface
2156
3dc1970d
LC
2157GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2158define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2159write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2160familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2161its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2162turned into concrete build actions.
2163
ba55b1cb 2164Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
3dc1970d 2165standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
834129e0 2166@file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
3dc1970d
LC
2167setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2168build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2169
2170@cindex derivation
2171Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2172store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2173provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2174representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2175which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
49ad317a
LC
2176assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2177that build results @emph{derive} from them.
3dc1970d
LC
2178
2179This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2180package definitions.
2181
568717fd 2182@menu
b860f382 2183* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
7458bd0a 2184* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
b860f382
LC
2185* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2186* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2187* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
21b679f6 2188* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
568717fd
LC
2189@end menu
2190
2191@node Defining Packages
2192@section Defining Packages
2193
3dc1970d
LC
2194The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2195@code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2196example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2197package looks like this:
2198
2199@example
e7f34eb0
LC
2200(define-module (gnu packages hello)
2201 #:use-module (guix packages)
2202 #:use-module (guix download)
2203 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
a6dcdcac
SB
2204 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2205 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
b22a12fd 2206
79f5dd59 2207(define-public hello
3dc1970d
LC
2208 (package
2209 (name "hello")
17d8e33f 2210 (version "2.10")
3dc1970d 2211 (source (origin
17d8e33f
ML
2212 (method url-fetch)
2213 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2214 ".tar.gz"))
2215 (sha256
2216 (base32
2217 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
3dc1970d 2218 (build-system gnu-build-system)
7458bd0a 2219 (arguments `(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
3dc1970d 2220 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
7458bd0a
LC
2221 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2222 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
3dc1970d 2223 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
b22a12fd 2224 (license gpl3+)))
3dc1970d
LC
2225@end example
2226
2227@noindent
2228Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
e7f34eb0 2229of the various fields here. This expression binds variable @code{hello}
3dc1970d
LC
2230to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
2231(@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2232This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2233@code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2234returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2235
2f7d2d91
LC
2236With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2237the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2238@code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2239
e7f34eb0
LC
2240In the example above, @var{hello} is defined into a module of its own,
2241@code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2242necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2243modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2244the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2245
3dc1970d
LC
2246There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2247
2248@itemize
2249@item
a2bf4907
LC
2250The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2251(@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
3dc1970d
LC
2252Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2253meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2254
2255The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2256the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2257
2258The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2259being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2260integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6c365eca 2261base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
210cc920
LC
2262@code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2263hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
3dc1970d 2264
f9cc8971
LC
2265@cindex patches
2266When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2267listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2268Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2269
3dc1970d
LC
2270@item
2271@cindex GNU Build System
7458bd0a
LC
2272The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2273package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2274represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2275configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2276make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2277
2278@item
2279The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2280(@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2281@var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2282@code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
3dc1970d
LC
2283
2284@item
2285The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2286build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2287input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2288variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2289
2290Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2291be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
7458bd0a 2292of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
3dc1970d
LC
2293
2294However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2295@code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2296unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2297@end itemize
2298
87eafdbd
TUBK
2299@xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2300
2f7d2d91 2301Once a package definition is in place, the
e49951eb 2302package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
39bee8a2
LC
2303tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2304package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2305(@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2306@xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
b4f5e0e8
CR
2307more information on how to test package definitions, and
2308@ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2309for style conformance.
2310
7458bd0a
LC
2311Eventually, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
2312can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2313(@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
3dc1970d
LC
2314
2315Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2316object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
834129e0 2317That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
ba55b1cb 2318The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
3dc1970d
LC
2319@code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2320
2321@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2322Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2323(@pxref{Derivations}).
3dc1970d
LC
2324
2325@var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2326must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2327@code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2328must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2329(@pxref{The Store}).
2330@end deffn
568717fd 2331
9c1edabd
LC
2332@noindent
2333@cindex cross-compilation
2334Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2335package for some other system:
2336
2337@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2338 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2339Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2340@var{system} to @var{target}.
9c1edabd
LC
2341
2342@var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2343and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2344(@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2345Configure and Build System}).
2346@end deffn
2347
87eafdbd
TUBK
2348@menu
2349* package Reference :: The package data type.
2350* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2351@end menu
2352
2353
2354@node package Reference
2355@subsection @code{package} Reference
2356
2357This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2358declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2359
2360@deftp {Data Type} package
2361This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2362
2363@table @asis
2364@item @code{name}
2365The name of the package, as a string.
2366
2367@item @code{version}
2368The version of the package, as a string.
2369
2370@item @code{source}
2371An origin object telling how the source code for the package should be
2372acquired (@pxref{origin Reference}).
2373
2374@item @code{build-system}
2375The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2376Systems}).
2377
2378@item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2379The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2380list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2381
2382@item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
70650c68
LC
2383@itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2384@itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2385@cindex inputs, of packages
2386These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2387tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2388first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2389and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2390defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
2391more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies 3
2392inputs:
87eafdbd 2393
70650c68
LC
2394@example
2395`(("libffi" ,libffi)
2396 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2397 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2398@end example
2399
2400@cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2401The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2402necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2403dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2404architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2405are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2406
2407@code{native-inputs} is typically where you would list tools needed at
2408build time but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
2409Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2410this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2411
2412@anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2413Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
2414specified packages will be force-installed alongside the package they
2415belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
2416package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2417propagated inputs.)
21461f27 2418
e0508b6b
LC
2419For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2420another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2421one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2422
2423Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for
2424languages that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin
2425to ELF's @code{RUNPATH}; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, GHC, and
2426more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2427library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2428listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
87eafdbd 2429
87eafdbd
TUBK
2430@item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2431This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2432a native input when cross-compiling.
2433
2434@item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2435The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2436Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2437
2438@item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2439@itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2440A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2441search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2442
2443@item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
2444This must either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
2445@dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2446for details.
2447
2448@item @code{synopsis}
2449A one-line description of the package.
2450
2451@item @code{description}
2452A more elaborate description of the package.
2453
2454@item @code{license}
2455The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)}.
2456
2457@item @code{home-page}
2458The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2459
2460@item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2461The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2462@code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2463
2464@item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2465The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2466
2467@item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
2468The source location of the package. It's useful to override this when
2469inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2470automatically corrected.
2471@end table
2472@end deftp
2473
2474
2475@node origin Reference
2476@subsection @code{origin} Reference
2477
2478This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2479declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2480
2481@deftp {Data Type} origin
2482This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2483
2484@table @asis
2485@item @code{uri}
2486An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2487the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2488@var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2489values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2490
2491@item @code{method}
2492A procedure that will handle the URI.
2493
2494Examples include:
2495
2496@table @asis
2497@item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
2498download a file the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
2499@code{uri} field;
2500
2501@item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2502clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2503specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2504@code{git-reference} looks like this:
2505
2506@example
2507(git-reference
2508 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2509 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2510@end example
2511@end table
2512
2513@item @code{sha256}
2514A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2515@code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2516base-32 string.
2517
2518@item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2519The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2520@code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2521the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
2522used. For version control checkouts, it's recommended to provide the
2523file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2524
2525@item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2526A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2527
2528@item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2529A quoted piece of code that will be run in the source directory to make
2530any modifications, which is sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2531
2532@item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2533A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2534command.
2535
2536@item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2537Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2538@code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2539such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2540
2541@item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2542A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2543process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2544
2545@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @code{'()})
2546The list of Guile modules to import in the patch derivation, for use by
2547the @code{snippet}.
2548
2549@item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2550The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2551this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2552@end table
2553@end deftp
2554
9c1edabd 2555
7458bd0a
LC
2556@node Build Systems
2557@section Build Systems
2558
2559@cindex build system
2560Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
2561that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
2562field represents the build procedure of the package, as well implicit
2563dependencies of that build procedure.
2564
2565Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
2566create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
2567module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
2568
f5fd4fd2 2569@cindex bag (low-level package representation)
0d5a559f
LC
2570Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
2571@dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
2572ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
2573a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
2574that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
2575representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
2576
7458bd0a
LC
2577Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
2578definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
2579(@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
2580(@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
2581Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
2582evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
2583by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
2584
2585The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
2586standard build procedure for GNU packages and many other packages. It
2587is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
2588
2589@defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
2590@var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
2591thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
2592standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
2593
2594@cindex build phases
2595In a nutshell, packages using it configured, built, and installed with
2596the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
2597command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
2598All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
2599notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
2600modules for more details about the build phases.}:
2601
2602@table @code
2603@item unpack
2604Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
2605extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
2606to the build tree, and enter that directory.
2607
2608@item patch-source-shebangs
2609Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
2610store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
2611@code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
2612
2613@item configure
2614Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
2615as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
2616by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
2617
2618@item build
2619Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
0917e80e 2620@code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7458bd0a
LC
2621(the default), build with @code{make -j}.
2622
2623@item check
2624Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
2625@code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
2626@code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
2627check -j}.
2628
2629@item install
2630Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
2631
2632@item patch-shebangs
2633Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
2634
2635@item strip
2636Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
2637is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
2638(@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
2639@end table
2640
2641@vindex %standard-phases
2642The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
2643@var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
2644@var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
2645procedure implements the actual phase.
2646
2647The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
2648@code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
2649
2650@example
2651#:phases (alist-delete 'configure %standard-phases)
2652@end example
2653
9bf404e9 2654means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
7458bd0a
LC
2655@code{configure} phase.
2656
2657In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
2658for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
2659Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
2660build-system gnu)} module for a complete list.) We call these the
2661@dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions don't
2662have to mention them.
2663@end defvr
2664
2665Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
2666conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
2667of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
2668implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
2669executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
2670
2671@defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
2672This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
2673implements the build procedure for packages using the
2674@url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
2675
2676It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
2677Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
2678parameter.
9849cfc1
LC
2679
2680The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
2681passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
2682parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
2683it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
2684debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
2685@code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7458bd0a
LC
2686@end defvr
2687
3afcf52b
FB
2688@defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
2689This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
2690is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
2691
2692This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
2693@var{gnu-build-system}:
2694
2695@table @code
2696@item glib-or-gtk-wrap
2697The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs found under
2698@file{bin/} are able to find GLib's ``schemas'' and
2699@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
2700modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
2701that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
2702environment variables.
2703
73aa8ddb
LC
2704It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
2705process by listing their names in the
2706@code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
2707when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
2708where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
2709GLib and GTK+.
2710
3afcf52b
FB
2711@item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
2712The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all GLib's
2713@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
2714GSettings schemas} are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
2715@command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
2716@code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
2717The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
2718specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
2719@end table
2720
2721Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
2722@end defvr
2723
7458bd0a
LC
2724@defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
2725This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
2726implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
2727packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
2728then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
2729
2730For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
2731it takes care of wrapping these programs so their @code{PYTHONPATH}
2732environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
2733
2734Which Python package is used can be specified with the @code{#:python}
2735parameter.
2736@end defvr
2737
2738@defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
2739This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
2d2a53fc
EB
2740implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
2741consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
2742followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
2743@code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
2744@code{make} and @code{make install}; depending on which of
2745@code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
2746distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
2747and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
2748preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
2749@code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
2750
2751The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
2752passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
2753@code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7458bd0a
LC
2754
2755Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
2756@end defvr
2757
f8f3bef6
RW
2758@defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
2759This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
2760implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
2761packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
2762INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
2763@code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
2764are run after installation using the R function
2765@code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
2766@end defvr
2767
c08f9818
DT
2768@defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
2769This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
2770implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
2771involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
2772
5dc87623
DT
2773The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
2774typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
2775developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
2776the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
2777repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
2778tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
2779a traditional source release tarball.
e83c6d00 2780
c08f9818 2781Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6e9f2913
PP
2782parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
2783command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
c08f9818 2784@end defvr
7458bd0a 2785
a677c726
RW
2786@defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
2787This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
2788implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
2789phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
2790implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
2791script.
2792
2793The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
2794Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
2795@code{#:python} parameter.
2796@end defvr
2797
14dfdf2e
FB
2798@defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
2799This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
2800implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
2801involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
2802--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
2803Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
2804install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
2805compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
2806Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
2807addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
2808running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
2809is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
2810the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
2811not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
2812
2813Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
a54bd6d7 2814parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
14dfdf2e
FB
2815@end defvr
2816
e9137a53
FB
2817@defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
2818This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
2819implements an installation procedure similar to the one of Emacs' own
2820packaging system (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
2821
2822It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
2823byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
2824packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
2825documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
2826package is installed in its own directory under
2827@file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
2828@end defvr
2829
7458bd0a
LC
2830Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
2831``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
2832it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
2833and does not have a notion of build phases.
2834
2835@defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
2836This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
2837
2838This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
2839must be a Scheme expression that builds the package's output(s)---as
2840with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
2841@code{build-expression->derivation}}).
2842@end defvr
2843
568717fd
LC
2844@node The Store
2845@section The Store
2846
e531ac2a
LC
2847@cindex store
2848@cindex store paths
2849
2850Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is where derivations that have been
834129e0 2851successfully built are stored---by default, under @file{/gnu/store}.
e531ac2a 2852Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store paths}. The
4988dd40 2853store has an associated database that contains information such as the
e531ac2a
LC
2854store paths referred to by each store path, and the list of @emph{valid}
2855store paths---paths that result from a successful build.
2856
2857The store is always accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
2858(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
2859connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send it requests, and
2860read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
2861
2862The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
2863daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
2864
2865@deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
2866Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
2867@var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
2868extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
2869operate, should the disk become full. Return a server object.
2870
2871@var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
2872location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
2873@end deffn
2874
2875@deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
2876Close the connection to @var{server}.
2877@end deffn
2878
2879@defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
2880This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
2881where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
2882@end defvr
2883
2884Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
2885argument.
2886
2887@deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
2888Return @code{#t} when @var{path} is a valid store path.
2889@end deffn
2890
cfbf9160 2891@deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
e531ac2a
LC
2892Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
2893path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
2894resulting store path.
2895@end deffn
2896
874e6874 2897@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
59688fc4
LC
2898Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
2899derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
2900Return @code{#t} on success.
874e6874
LC
2901@end deffn
2902
b860f382
LC
2903Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
2904monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
2905more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
2906Store Monad}).
2907
e531ac2a
LC
2908@c FIXME
2909@i{This section is currently incomplete.}
568717fd
LC
2910
2911@node Derivations
2912@section Derivations
2913
874e6874
LC
2914@cindex derivations
2915Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
2916are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contain the
2917following pieces of information:
2918
2919@itemize
2920@item
2921The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
2922directory in the store, but may produce more.
2923
2924@item
2925The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
2926files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
2927
2928@item
2929The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
2930
2931@item
2932The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
2933to be passed.
2934
2935@item
2936A list of environment variables to be defined.
2937
2938@end itemize
2939
2940@cindex derivation path
2941Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
2942the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
2943both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
2944name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
2945paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
2946procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
2947Store}).
2948
2949The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
2950derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
2951otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
2952a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
2953
1909431c
LC
2954@deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
2955 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
2096ef47 2956 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
1909431c 2957 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
4a6aeb67
LC
2958 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
2959 [#:substitutable? #t]
59688fc4
LC
2960Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
2961@code{<derivation>} object.
874e6874 2962
2096ef47 2963When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
874e6874 2964@dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
36bbbbd1
LC
2965known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
2966@var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
2967file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
2968containing this output.
5b0c9d16 2969
858e9282 2970When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
5b0c9d16
LC
2971name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
2972path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
2973a simple text format.
1909431c 2974
b53be755
LC
2975When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
2976or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to.
2977
c0468155
LC
2978When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
2979denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
2980daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
2981to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
2982use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
2983derivations that download files.
2984
1909431c
LC
2985When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
2986good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
2987(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
2988where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
4a6aeb67
LC
2989
2990When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
2991derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
2992useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
2993host CPU instruction set.
874e6874
LC
2994@end deffn
2995
2996@noindent
2997Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
2998@var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
2999to a Bash executable in the store:
3000
3001@lisp
3002(use-modules (guix utils)
3003 (guix store)
3004 (guix derivations))
3005
59688fc4
LC
3006(let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3007 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3008 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3009 (derivation store "foo"
3010 bash `("-e" ,builder)
21b679f6 3011 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
59688fc4 3012 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
834129e0 3013@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
874e6874
LC
3014@end lisp
3015
21b679f6
LC
3016As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3017better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3018best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3019``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6621cdb6 3020information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
21b679f6
LC
3021
3022Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3023derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3024@code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3025is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
874e6874 3026
dd1a5a15
LC
3027@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3028 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3029 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3030 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
36bbbbd1 3031 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
63a42824 3032 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
4a6aeb67 3033 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
874e6874
LC
3034Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3035builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3036@code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3037@code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3038modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3039compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3040@var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3041gnu-build-system))}.
3042
3043@var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3044to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3045to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3046Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3047and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3048terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3049@var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3050
3051@var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3052@var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3053@code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
9c629a27 3054
63a42824 3055See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
4a6aeb67
LC
3056@var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references}, @var{local-build?},
3057and @var{substitutable?}.
874e6874
LC
3058@end deffn
3059
3060@noindent
3061Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3062containing one file:
3063
3064@lisp
3065(let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
834129e0 3066 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
874e6874
LC
3067 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3068 (lambda (p)
3069 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
dd1a5a15 3070 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
874e6874 3071
834129e0 3072@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
874e6874
LC
3073@end lisp
3074
568717fd 3075
b860f382
LC
3076@node The Store Monad
3077@section The Store Monad
3078
3079@cindex monad
3080
3081The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3082sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3083argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3084side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3085
3086The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3087carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3088functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3089latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3090and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3091
3092@cindex monadic values
3093@cindex monadic functions
3094This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3095provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3096useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3097construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3098(in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
561fb6c3 3099computations (here computations include accesses to the store.) Values
b860f382
LC
3100in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3101@dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3102@dfn{monadic procedures}.
3103
3104Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3105
3106@example
45adbd62
LC
3107(define (sh-symlink store)
3108 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3109 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3110 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3111 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3112 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3113 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
b860f382
LC
3114@end example
3115
c6f30b81
LC
3116Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3117as a monadic function:
b860f382
LC
3118
3119@example
45adbd62 3120(define (sh-symlink)
b860f382 3121 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
c6f30b81
LC
3122 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3123 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3124 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3125 #$output))))
b860f382
LC
3126@end example
3127
c6f30b81
LC
3128There several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3129parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3130@code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3131procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3132is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3133
3134As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3135omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3136(@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3137
3138@example
3139(define (sh-symlink)
3140 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3141 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3142 #$output)))
3143@end example
b860f382 3144
7ce21611
LC
3145@c See
3146@c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3147@c for the funny quote.
3148Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3149said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3150So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3151@code{run-with-store}:
b860f382
LC
3152
3153@example
8e9aa37f
CAW
3154(run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3155@result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
b860f382
LC
3156@end example
3157
b9b86078
LC
3158Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends Guile's REPL with
3159new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
3160@code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former, is used
3161to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3162
3163@example
3164scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3165$1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3166@end example
3167
3168The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3169automatically run through the store:
3170
3171@example
3172scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3173store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3174$2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3175store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3176$3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3177store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3178scheme@@(guile-user)>
3179@end example
3180
3181@noindent
3182Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3183@code{store-monad} REPL.
3184
e87f0591
LC
3185The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3186the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
b860f382
LC
3187
3188@deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3189Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3190in @var{monad}.
3191@end deffn
3192
3193@deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3194Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3195@end deffn
3196
751630c9 3197@deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
b860f382 3198@dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
751630c9
LC
3199procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3200referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3201Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3202Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3203in this example:
3204
3205@example
3206(run-with-state
3207 (with-monad %state-monad
3208 (>>= (return 1)
3209 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3210 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3211 'some-state)
3212
3213@result{} 4
3214@result{} some-state
3215@end example
b860f382
LC
3216@end deffn
3217
3218@deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3219 @var{body} ...
3220@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3221 @var{body} ...
3222Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3223@var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3224``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3225
3226@code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3227(@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3228@end deffn
3229
405a9d4e
LC
3230@deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3231Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3232returning the result of the last expression.
3233
3234This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3235monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3236@code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3237@end deffn
3238
561fb6c3
LC
3239@cindex state monad
3240The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3241allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3242monadic procedure calls.
3243
3244@defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3245The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3246the state that is threaded.
3247
3248Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3249in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3250increments the current state value:
3251
3252@example
3253(define (square x)
3254 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3255 (mbegin %state-monad
3256 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3257 (return (* x x)))))
3258
3259(run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3260@result{} (0 1 4)
3261@result{} 3
3262@end example
3263
3264When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3265value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3266@end defvr
3267
3268@deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3269Return the current state as a monadic value.
3270@end deffn
3271
3272@deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3273Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3274monadic value.
3275@end deffn
3276
3277@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3278Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3279and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3280@end deffn
3281
3282@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3283Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3284The state is assumed to be a list.
3285@end deffn
3286
3287@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3288Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3289state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3290@end deffn
3291
e87f0591
LC
3292The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3293store)} module, is as follows.
b860f382
LC
3294
3295@defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
561fb6c3
LC
3296The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3297
3298Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3299effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3300passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
b860f382
LC
3301@end defvr
3302
3303@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3304Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3305open store connection.
3306@end deffn
3307
ad372953 3308@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
b860f382 3309Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
ad372953
LC
3310containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3311resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
45adbd62
LC
3312@end deffn
3313
0a90af15
LC
3314@deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3315 [#:recursive? #t]
3316Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3317@var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3318@var{name} is omitted.
3319
3320When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3321recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3322is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3323
3324The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3325
3326@example
3327(run-with-store (open-connection)
3328 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3329 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3330 (return (list a b))))
3331
3332@result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3333@end example
3334
3335@end deffn
3336
e87f0591
LC
3337The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3338monadic procedures:
3339
b860f382 3340@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
4231f05b
LC
3341 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
3342 [#:output "out"] Return as a monadic
b860f382
LC
3343value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3344directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
4231f05b
LC
3345of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3346true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
b860f382
LC
3347@end deffn
3348
b860f382 3349@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
4231f05b
LC
3350@deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3351 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3352Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3353@code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
b860f382
LC
3354@end deffn
3355
3356
21b679f6
LC
3357@node G-Expressions
3358@section G-Expressions
3359
3360@cindex G-expression
3361@cindex build code quoting
3362So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3363to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
3364Those build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
3365build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3366(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3367
3368@cindex strata of code
3369It should come as no surprise that we like to write those build actions
3370in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3371code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
ef4ab0a4
LC
3372Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3373Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3374@url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3375on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3376@dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3377to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3378performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3379@command{make}, etc.
21b679f6
LC
3380
3381To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3382embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
3383code as data, and Scheme's homoiconicity---code has a direct
3384representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
3385Scheme's normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism to construct build
3386expressions.
3387
3388The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3389S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
3390@dfn{gexps}, consist essentially in three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
3391@code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
3392@code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable respectively to
3393@code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing}
3394(@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile, GNU Guile
3395Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
3396
3397@itemize
3398@item
3399Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3400processes.
3401
3402@item
b39fc6f7
LC
3403When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3404inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3405introduced.
ff40e9b7 3406
21b679f6
LC
3407@item
3408Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3409and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3410processes that use them.
3411@end itemize
3412
c2b84676 3413@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
343eacbe
LC
3414This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3415objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
c2b84676
LC
3416derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3417such that these objects can also be inserted
343eacbe
LC
3418into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level object that can be
3419inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
3420add files to the store and refer to them in
558e8b11
LC
3421derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3422below.)
b39fc6f7 3423
21b679f6
LC
3424To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3425
3426@example
3427(define build-exp
3428 #~(begin
3429 (mkdir #$output)
3430 (chdir #$output)
aff8ce7c 3431 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
21b679f6
LC
3432 "list-files")))
3433@end example
3434
3435This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3436derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3437@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3438
3439@example
3440(gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
3441@end example
3442
e20fd1bf 3443As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
21b679f6
LC
3444substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
3445actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
3446the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
3447output)}) is replaced by a string containing the derivation's output
667b2508
LC
3448directory name.
3449
3450@cindex cross compilation
3451In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
3452references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
3453host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
3454@code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
3455native package build:
3456
3457@example
3458(gexp->derivation "vi"
3459 #~(begin
3460 (mkdir #$output)
3461 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
3462 "-s"
3463 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
3464 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
3465 #:target "mips64el-linux")
3466@end example
3467
3468@noindent
3469In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
3470that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
3471cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
3472
3473The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
21b679f6
LC
3474
3475@deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
3476@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
3477Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
3478or more of the following forms:
3479
3480@table @code
3481@item #$@var{obj}
3482@itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
b39fc6f7
LC
3483Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
3484supported types, for example a package or a
21b679f6
LC
3485derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
3486output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
3487
b39fc6f7
LC
3488If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
3489objects are substituted similarly.
21b679f6
LC
3490
3491If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
3492dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
3493
3494If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
3495
b39fc6f7
LC
3496@item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
3497@itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
21b679f6 3498This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
b39fc6f7
LC
3499@var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
3500multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
21b679f6 3501
667b2508
LC
3502@item #+@var{obj}
3503@itemx #+@var{obj}:output
3504@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
3505@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
3506Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
3507build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
3508
21b679f6
LC
3509@item #$output[:@var{output}]
3510@itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
3511Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
3512output when @var{output} is omitted.
3513
3514This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3515
3516@item #$@@@var{lst}
3517@itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
3518Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
3519containing list.
3520
667b2508
LC
3521@item #+@@@var{lst}
3522@itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
3523Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
3524@var{lst}.
3525
21b679f6
LC
3526@end table
3527
3528G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
3529of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
3530@end deffn
3531
3532@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
3533Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
3534@end deffn
3535
3536G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
3537some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
3538below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
3539information about monads.)
3540
3541@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
ce45eb4c 3542 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
21b679f6
LC
3543 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3544 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
4684f301 3545 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
c8351d9a 3546 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
c0468155 3547 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
0309e1b0 3548 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
4a6aeb67 3549 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
21b679f6 3550Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
0309e1b0
LC
3551@var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
3552stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
3553it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
3554to by @var{exp}.
21b679f6 3555
ce45eb4c
LC
3556Make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
3557@var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
3558@var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
21b679f6
LC
3559the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
3560build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
3561
ce45eb4c
LC
3562@var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
3563applicable.
3564
b53833b2
LC
3565When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
3566following forms:
3567
3568@example
3569(@var{file-name} @var{package})
3570(@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
3571(@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
3572(@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
3573(@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
3574@end example
3575
3576The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
3577an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
3578@var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
3579text format.
3580
c8351d9a
LC
3581@var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
3582In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
3583refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
3584
e20fd1bf 3585The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
21b679f6
LC
3586@end deffn
3587
343eacbe 3588@cindex file-like objects
e1c153e0
LC
3589The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
3590@code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
3591@dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
3592these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
343eacbe
LC
3593
3594@example
3595#~(system* (string-append #$glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
3596 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
3597@end example
3598
3599The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
3600to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
3601@code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
3602@file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
3603does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
3604@code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
3605content is directly passed as a string.
3606
d9ae938f
LC
3607@deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3608 [#:recursive? #t]
3609Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
9d3994f7
LC
3610object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
3611up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
3612the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
d9ae938f
LC
3613
3614When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
3615designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
3616permission bits are kept.
3617
3618This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
3619procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
3620@end deffn
3621
558e8b11
LC
3622@deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
3623Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
3624@var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
3625
3626This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
3627@end deffn
3628
91937029
LC
3629@deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
3630 [#:modules '()] [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
3631Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
3632directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{modules} specifies the set of
3633modules visible in the execution context of @var{gexp}. @var{options}
3634is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3635
3636This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
3637@end deffn
3638
21b679f6
LC
3639@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
3640Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
3641@var{guile} with @var{modules} in its search path.
3642
3643The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
3644command:
3645
3646@example
3647(use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
3648
3649(gexp->script "list-files"
3650 #~(execl (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3651 "ls"))
3652@end example
3653
3654When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
e20fd1bf 3655@code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
21b679f6
LC
3656executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
3657
3658@example
3659#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
3660!#
3661(execl (string-append "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls")
3662 "ls")
3663@end example
3664@end deffn
3665
15a01c72
LC
3666@deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
3667 [#:modules '()] [#:guile #f]
3668Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
3669runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
3670script, and @var{modules} is the list of modules visible to that script.
3671
3672This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
3673@end deffn
3674
21b679f6
LC
3675@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp}
3676Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
3677
3678The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
3679or a subset thereof.
3680@end deffn
1ed19464 3681
e1c153e0
LC
3682@deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
3683Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
3684@var{exp}.
3685
3686This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
3687@end deffn
3688
1ed19464
LC
3689@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3690Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
3691containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
d9ae938f
LC
3692strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
3693derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
3694references to all these.
1ed19464
LC
3695
3696This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
3697to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
3698case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
3699like this:
3700
3701@example
3702(define (profile.sh)
3703 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
3704 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
3705 (text-file* "profile.sh"
3706 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
3707 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
3708@end example
3709
3710In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
3711will references @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
3712preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
3713@end deffn
21b679f6 3714
b751cde3
LC
3715@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3716Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
3717@var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
3718as in:
3719
3720@example
3721(mixed-text-file "profile"
3722 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
3723@end example
3724
3725This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
3726@end deffn
3727
21b679f6
LC
3728Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
3729also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
3730meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
3731@code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
3732
c2b84676
LC
3733@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3734Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
3735to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
3736yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
3737item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
3738
3739@deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
3740 [#:target #f]
3741Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
3742corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
3743@var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
3744has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
3745@end deffn
3746
21b679f6 3747
568717fd
LC
3748@c *********************************************************************
3749@node Utilities
3750@chapter Utilities
3751
210cc920
LC
3752This section describes tools primarily targeted at developers and users
3753who write new package definitions. They complement the Scheme
3754programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
3755
568717fd 3756@menu
37166310 3757* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
39bee8a2 3758* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
210cc920 3759* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
37166310 3760* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
2f7d2d91 3761* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
37166310 3762* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
b4f5e0e8 3763* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 3764* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 3765* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
372c4bbc 3766* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 3767* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 3768* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 3769* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
568717fd
LC
3770@end menu
3771
e49951eb
MW
3772@node Invoking guix build
3773@section Invoking @command{guix build}
568717fd 3774
e49951eb 3775The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
6798a8e4
LC
3776their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
3777does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
e49951eb 3778@command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
6798a8e4
LC
3779it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
3780
3781The general syntax is:
c78bd12b
LC
3782
3783@example
e49951eb 3784guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
c78bd12b
LC
3785@end example
3786
ccd7158d
LC
3787As an example, the following command builds the latest version of Emacs
3788and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
3789resulting directories:
3790
3791@example
3792guix build emacs guile
3793@end example
3794
3795Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
3796
3797@example
3798guix build --keep-going \
3799 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
3800@end example
3801
c78bd12b 3802@var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
5401dd75
LC
3803the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
3804@code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
834129e0 3805@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
e7f34eb0
LC
3806package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
3807for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3808
3809Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
3810Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
3811disambiguation among several same-named packages or package variants is
3812needed.
c78bd12b 3813
ccd7158d
LC
3814There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
3815described in the subsections below.
3816
3817@menu
3818* Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
88ad6ded 3819* Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
ccd7158d
LC
3820* Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
3821@end menu
3822
3823@node Common Build Options
3824@subsection Common Build Options
3825
3826A number of options that control the build process are common to
3827@command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
3828@command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
3829following:
3830
3831@table @code
3832
3833@item --load-path=@var{directory}
3834@itemx -L @var{directory}
3835Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
3836(@pxref{Package Modules}).
3837
3838This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
3839the command-line tools.
3840
3841@item --keep-failed
3842@itemx -K
3843Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fail, its build
3844tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
3845the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
3846
3847@item --keep-going
3848@itemx -k
3849Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
3850all the builds have either completed or failed.
3851
3852The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
3853derivations has failed.
3854
3855@item --dry-run
3856@itemx -n
3857Do not build the derivations.
3858
3859@item --fallback
3860When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
3861packages locally.
3862
3863@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
3864@anchor{client-substitute-urls}
3865Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
3866URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
3867(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
3868
3869This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
3870they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
3871(@pxref{Substitutes}).
3872
3873@item --no-substitutes
3874Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
3875locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
3876(@pxref{Substitutes}).
3877
3878@item --rounds=@var{n}
3879Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
3880consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
3881
3882This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
3883Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
3884practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
3885binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
3886
3887Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
3888so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
3889stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export},
3890then rebuilding, and finally comparing the two results.
3891
3892@item --no-build-hook
3893Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the daemon's ``build hook''
3894(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
3895instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
3896
3897@item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
3898When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
3899@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
3900
3901@item --timeout=@var{seconds}
3902Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
3903@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
3904
3905By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
3906@code{--timeout=0}.
3907
3908@item --verbosity=@var{level}
3909Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
3910and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
3911may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
3912
3913@item --cores=@var{n}
3914@itemx -c @var{n}
3915Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
3916value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
3917
3918@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
3919@itemx -M @var{n}
3920Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
3921guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
3922equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
3923
3924@end table
3925
3926Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
3927the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
3928module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
3929derivations)} module.
3930
3931In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
3932@command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
3933building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
3934
3935@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
3936Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
3937will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
3938@command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
3939below:
3940
3941@example
3942$ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
3943@end example
3944
3945These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
3946the parsed command-line options.
3947@end defvr
3948
88ad6ded
LC
3949
3950@node Package Transformation Options
3951@subsection Package Transformation Options
3952
3953@cindex package variants
3954Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
b8638f03
LC
3955and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
3956options}. These are options that allow you to define @dfn{package
3957variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
3958This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
3959without having to type in the definitions of package variants
3960(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
88ad6ded
LC
3961
3962@table @code
3963
3964@item --with-source=@var{source}
3965Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
3966@var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
3967download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
3968
3969The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be one specified on the
3970command line whose name matches the base of @var{source}---e.g., if
3971@var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
3972package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
3973@var{source}; in the previous example, it's @code{2.0.10}.
3974
3975This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
3976one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
3977@file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
3978the @code{ed} package:
3979
3980@example
3981guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
3982@end example
3983
3984As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
3985candidates:
3986
3987@example
3988guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
3989@end example
3990
3991@dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
3992
3993@example
3994$ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
3995$ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
3996@end example
3997
47c0f92c
LC
3998@item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
3999Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
4000@var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
4001@var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
4002or @code{guile@@1.8}.
4003
4004For instance, the following command builds Guix but replaces its
4005dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
4006the development version of Guile, @code{guile-next}:
4007
4008@example
4009guix build --with-input=guile=guile-next guix
4010@end example
4011
4012This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
4013@code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
4014@code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile-next}.
4015
4016However, implicit inputs are left unchanged.
88ad6ded
LC
4017@end table
4018
ccd7158d
LC
4019@node Additional Build Options
4020@subsection Additional Build Options
4021
4022The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
4023build}.
c78bd12b
LC
4024
4025@table @code
4026
34a1783f
DT
4027@item --file=@var{file}
4028@itemx -f @var{file}
4029
4030Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
4031evaluates to.
4032
4033As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
4034(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4035
4036@example
4037@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
4038@end example
4039
c78bd12b
LC
4040@item --expression=@var{expr}
4041@itemx -e @var{expr}
ac5de156 4042Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
c78bd12b 4043
5401dd75 4044For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
c78bd12b
LC
4045guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
4046version 1.8 of Guile.
4047
56b82106
LC
4048Alternately, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
4049as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
4050(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
4051
4052Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
ac5de156
LC
4053(@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
4054monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
4055
c78bd12b
LC
4056@item --source
4057@itemx -S
4058Build the packages' source derivations, rather than the packages
4059themselves.
4060
e49951eb 4061For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
834129e0 4062@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is GCC's source tarball.
c78bd12b 4063
f9cc8971
LC
4064The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
4065code snippets specified in the package's @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
4066Packages}).
4067
2cdfe13d
EB
4068@item --sources
4069Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
4070dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
4071of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
4072eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
4073of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
4074optional argument values:
4075
4076@table @code
4077@item package
4078This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
4079as the @code{--source} option.
4080
4081@item all
4082Build all packages' source derivations, including any source that might
4083be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
4084
4085@example
4086$ guix build --sources tzdata
4087The following derivations will be built:
4088 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
4089 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4090@end example
4091
4092@item transitive
4093Build all packages' source derivations, as well as all source
4094derivations for packages' transitive inputs. This can be used e.g. to
4095prefetch package source for later offline building.
4096
4097@example
4098$ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
4099The following derivations will be built:
4100 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4101 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
4102 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
4103 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
4104 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
4105 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
4106@dots{}
4107@end example
4108
4109@end table
4110
c78bd12b
LC
4111@item --system=@var{system}
4112@itemx -s @var{system}
4113Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4114the host's system type.
4115
4116An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
4117different personalities. For instance, passing
4118@code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
4119to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
4120
e55ec43d
LC
4121@item --target=@var{triplet}
4122@cindex cross-compilation
4123Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4124as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
4125configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
4126
a8d65643
LC
4127@anchor{build-check}
4128@item --check
4129@cindex determinism, checking
4130@cindex reproducibility, checking
4131Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
4132store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
4133identical.
4134
4135This mechanism allows you to check whether previously-installed
4136substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether a package's
4137build result is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
4138background information and tools.
4139
05962f29
LC
4140@item --no-grafts
4141Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
4142available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4143information on grafts.
7f3673f2 4144
c78bd12b
LC
4145@item --derivations
4146@itemx -d
4147Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
4148packages.
4149
70ee5642
LC
4150@item --root=@var{file}
4151@itemx -r @var{file}
4152Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
4153collector root.
4154
4155@item --log-file
3f208ad7 4156Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
70ee5642
LC
4157@var{package-or-derivation}s, or raise an error if build logs are
4158missing.
4159
4160This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
4161instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
4162
4163@example
4164guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
4165guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
4166guix build --log-file guile
4167guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
4168@end example
4169
3f208ad7
LC
4170If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
4171passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
4172substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
70ee5642 4173
3f208ad7
LC
4174So for instance, let's say you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS
4175but you're actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
4176
4177@example
4178$ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
4179http://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
4180@end example
4181
4182You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
70ee5642
LC
4183@end table
4184
16eb115e 4185
39bee8a2
LC
4186@node Invoking guix edit
4187@section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4188
4189@cindex package definition, editing
4190So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4191facilitates the life of packagers by pointing their editor at the source
4192file containing the definition of the specified packages. For instance:
4193
4194@example
4195guix edit gcc-4.8 vim
4196@end example
4197
4198@noindent
6237b9fa
LC
4199launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4200@code{EDITOR} environment variable to edit the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.8.4
4201and that of Vim.
39bee8a2
LC
4202
4203If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides
6248e326
AK
4204similar functionality in the ``package info'' and ``package list''
4205buffers created by @kbd{M-x guix-search-by-name} and similar commands
4206(@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
39bee8a2
LC
4207
4208
210cc920
LC
4209@node Invoking guix download
4210@section Invoking @command{guix download}
4211
4212When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
4213the package's source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
4214hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4215@command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4216from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4217in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4218
4219The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4220when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4221with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4222downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4223convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4224eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4225
4226The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4227package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4228@code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4229Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
537c8bb3
LC
4230they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4231how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4232GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
210cc920
LC
4233
4234The following option is available:
4235
4236@table @code
4237@item --format=@var{fmt}
4238@itemx -f @var{fmt}
4239Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
081145cf 4240information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
210cc920
LC
4241@end table
4242
6c365eca
NK
4243@node Invoking guix hash
4244@section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4245
210cc920 4246The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
6c365eca
NK
4247It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4248distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4249used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4250
4251The general syntax is:
4252
4253@example
4254guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4255@end example
4256
4257@command{guix hash} has the following option:
4258
4259@table @code
4260
4261@item --format=@var{fmt}
4262@itemx -f @var{fmt}
210cc920 4263Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
6c365eca
NK
4264
4265Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4266(@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4267
4268If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4269will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4270in the definitions of packages.
4271
3140f2df
LC
4272@item --recursive
4273@itemx -r
4274Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
4275
4276In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
4277including its children if it is a directory. Some of @var{file}'s
4278meta-data is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
4279regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
4280executable or not. Meta-data such as time stamps has no impact on the
4281hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
4282@c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
4283@c it exists.
4284
6c365eca
NK
4285@end table
4286
2f7d2d91
LC
4287@node Invoking guix import
4288@section Invoking @command{guix import}
4289
4290@cindex importing packages
4291@cindex package import
4292@cindex package conversion
4293The @command{guix import} command is useful for people willing to add a
4294package to the distribution but who'd rather do as little work as
4295possible to get there---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
4296repositories from which it can ``import'' package meta-data. The result
4297is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
4298(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4299
4300The general syntax is:
4301
4302@example
4303guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
4304@end example
4305
4306@var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
4307meta-data, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
4308options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
4309``importers'' are:
4310
4311@table @code
4312@item gnu
4313Import meta-data for the given GNU package. This provides a template
4314for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
4315source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
4316
4317Additional information such as the package's dependencies and its
4318license needs to be figured out manually.
4319
4320For example, the following command returns a package definition for
4321GNU@tie{}Hello:
4322
4323@example
4324guix import gnu hello
4325@end example
4326
4327Specific command-line options are:
4328
4329@table @code
4330@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4331As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
4332keys when verifying the package's signature. @xref{Invoking guix
4333refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
4334@end table
4335
4336@item pypi
4337@cindex pypi
4338Import meta-data from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
4339Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4340@xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
4341description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
4342the relevant information, including package dependencies.
4343
4344The command below imports meta-data for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
4345package:
4346
4347@example
4348guix import pypi itsdangerous
4349@end example
4350
3aae8145
DT
4351@item gem
4352@cindex gem
4353Import meta-data from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
4354RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
4355installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
4356JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
4357most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
4358some caveats, however. The meta-data doesn't distinguish between
4359synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
4360Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
4361native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
4362packager.
4363
4364The command below imports meta-data for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
4365
4366@example
4367guix import gem rails
4368@end example
4369
d45dc6da
EB
4370@item cpan
4371@cindex CPAN
4372Import meta-data from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
4373Information is taken from the JSON-formatted meta-data provided through
4374@uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
66392e47
EB
4375relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
4376should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
4377@code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
4378list of dependencies.
d45dc6da
EB
4379
4380The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
4381Perl module:
4382
4383@example
4384guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
4385@end example
4386
e1248602
RW
4387@item cran
4388@cindex CRAN
d0bd632f 4389@cindex Bioconductor
e1248602
RW
4390Import meta-data from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
4391central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
4392statistical and graphical environment}.
4393
d0bd632f 4394Information is extracted from the package's @code{DESCRIPTION} file.
e1248602
RW
4395
4396The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{Cairo}
4397R package:
4398
4399@example
4400guix import cran Cairo
4401@end example
4402
d0bd632f
RW
4403When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, meta-data is imported from
4404@uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
4405packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
4406genomic data in bioinformatics.
4407
4408Information is extracted from a package's @code{DESCRIPTION} file
4409published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
4410
4411The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{GenomicRanges}
4412R package:
4413
4414@example
4415guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
4416@end example
4417
2f7d2d91
LC
4418@item nix
4419Import meta-data from a local copy of the source of the
4420@uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
4421relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
4422@uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
4423typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
4424command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
4425the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
4426package definition.
4427
4428When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
4429by their canonical upstream variant.
4430
961d0d2d
LC
4431Usually, you will first need to do:
4432
4433@example
4434export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
4435@end example
4436
4437@noindent
4438so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
4439
2f7d2d91
LC
4440As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
4441LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
4442bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
4443
4444@example
4445guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
4446@end example
863af4e1
FB
4447
4448@item hackage
4449@cindex hackage
4450Import meta-data from Haskell community's central package archive
4451@uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
4452Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
4453dependencies.
4454
4455Specific command-line options are:
4456
4457@table @code
a4154748
FB
4458@item --stdin
4459@itemx -s
4460Read a Cabal file from the standard input.
863af4e1
FB
4461@item --no-test-dependencies
4462@itemx -t
a4154748
FB
4463Do not include dependencies required by the test suites only.
4464@item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
4465@itemx -e @var{alist}
4466@var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
4467Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
4468@code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
4469The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
4470@code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
4471has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
4472associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
4473@samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc} respectively.
863af4e1
FB
4474@end table
4475
4476The command below imports meta-data for the latest version of the
a4154748
FB
4477@code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
4478specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
863af4e1
FB
4479
4480@example
a4154748 4481guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
863af4e1
FB
4482@end example
4483
4484A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
4485package name by a hyphen and a version number as in the following example:
4486
4487@example
4488guix import hackage mtl-2.1.3.1
4489@end example
7f74a931
FB
4490
4491@item elpa
4492@cindex elpa
4493Import meta-data from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
4494repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
4495
4496Specific command-line options are:
4497
4498@table @code
4499@item --archive=@var{repo}
4500@itemx -a @var{repo}
4501@var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
4502information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
4503are:
4504@itemize -
4505@item
840bd1d3 4506@uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
7f74a931
FB
4507identifier. This is the default.
4508
4509@item
840bd1d3 4510@uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
7f74a931
FB
4511@code{melpa-stable} identifier.
4512
4513@item
840bd1d3 4514@uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
7f74a931
FB
4515identifier.
4516@end itemize
4517@end table
2f7d2d91
LC
4518@end table
4519
4520The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
4521useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
4522is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
4523
37166310
LC
4524@node Invoking guix refresh
4525@section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
4526
4527The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
4528of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
4529provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
4530upstream version, like this:
4531
4532@example
4533$ guix refresh
4534gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
4535gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
4536@end example
4537
4538It does so by browsing each package's FTP directory and determining the
bcb571cb
LC
4539highest version number of the source tarballs therein. The command
4540knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
4541packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. The
4542are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
4543whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
4544extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
37166310
LC
4545
4546When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
4547update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those packages'
4548recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
4549each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
4550signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
4551using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
4552key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
4553attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
4554when it's successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
4555@command{guix refresh} reports an error.
4556
4557The following options are supported:
4558
4559@table @code
4560
2d7fc7da
LC
4561@item --expression=@var{expr}
4562@itemx -e @var{expr}
4563Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4564
4565This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4566
4567@example
4568guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
4569@end example
4570
4571This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
4572the packages.)
4573
37166310
LC
4574@item --update
4575@itemx -u
38e16b49
LC
4576Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
4577usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
4578Guix Before It Is Installed}):
4579
4580@example
4581$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core
4582@end example
4583
081145cf 4584@xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
37166310
LC
4585
4586@item --select=[@var{subset}]
4587@itemx -s @var{subset}
4588Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
4589@code{non-core}.
4590
4591The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
4592distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
4593else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
4594changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
4595all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
4596terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
4597
4598The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
4599typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
4600inconvenient.
4601
bcb571cb
LC
4602@item --type=@var{updater}
4603@itemx -t @var{updater}
7191adc5
AK
4604Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
4605list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
bcb571cb
LC
4606
4607@table @code
4608@item gnu
4609the updater for GNU packages;
e80c0f85
LC
4610@item gnome
4611the updater for GNOME packages;
bcb571cb 4612@item elpa
d882c235
LC
4613the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
4614@item cran
b9d044ef 4615the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
d0bd632f
RW
4616@item bioconductor
4617the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
bab020d7 4618@item pypi
b9d044ef 4619the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
bcb571cb
LC
4620@end table
4621
4622For instance, the following commands only checks for updates of Emacs
d882c235 4623packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and updates of CRAN packages:
bcb571cb
LC
4624
4625@example
7191adc5 4626$ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
d882c235 4627gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
bcb571cb
LC
4628gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
4629@end example
4630
37166310
LC
4631@end table
4632
4633In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
4634names, as in this example:
4635
4636@example
38e16b49 4637$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc-4.8.4
37166310
LC
4638@end example
4639
4640@noindent
4641The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
4642@code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
4643effect in this case.
4644
7d193ec3
EB
4645When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
4646convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
4647should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
4648be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
4649
4650@table @code
4651
6ffa706b
AK
4652@item --list-updaters
4653@itemx -L
4654List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
4655
7d193ec3
EB
4656@item --list-dependent
4657@itemx -l
4658List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
4659result of upgrading one or more packages.
4660
4661@end table
4662
4663Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
4664@emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
4665an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
4666
4667@example
7779ab61
LC
4668$ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
4669Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
4670hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
7d193ec3
EB
4671@end example
4672
4673The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
4674for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
4675
f9230085
LC
4676The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
4677
4678@table @code
4679
f9230085
LC
4680@item --gpg=@var{command}
4681Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
4682for in @code{$PATH}.
4683
2bc53ba9
LC
4684@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4685Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
4686of:
4687
4688@table @code
4689@item always
4690Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
4691to the user's GnuPG keyring.
4692
4693@item never
4694Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
4695
4696@item interactive
4697When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
4698the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
4699@end table
4700
4701@item --key-server=@var{host}
4702Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
4703
f9230085
LC
4704@end table
4705
b4f5e0e8
CR
4706@node Invoking guix lint
4707@section Invoking @command{guix lint}
4708The @command{guix lint} is meant to help package developers avoid common
873c4085
LC
4709errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on a
4710given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
4711definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
4712@code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
4713
4714@table @code
4715@item synopsis
4716@itemx description
4717Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
4718descriptions and synopses.
4719
4720@item inputs-should-be-native
4721Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
4722
4723@item source
4724@itemx home-page
50f5c46d 4725@itemx source-file-name
873c4085 4726Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
50f5c46d
EB
4727invalid. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
4728just a version number or ``git-checkout'', and should not have a
4729@code{file-name} declared (@pxref{origin Reference}).
40a7d4e5 4730
5432734b
LC
4731@item cve
4732Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
4733Exposures (CVE) database
4734@uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
4735NIST}.
4736
40a7d4e5
LC
4737@item formatting
4738Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
4739use of tabulations, etc.
873c4085 4740@end table
b4f5e0e8
CR
4741
4742The general syntax is:
4743
4744@example
4745guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4746@end example
4747
4748If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
4749The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
4750
4751@table @code
4752
dd7c013d
CR
4753@item --checkers
4754@itemx -c
4755Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
4756names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
4757
b4f5e0e8
CR
4758@item --list-checkers
4759@itemx -l
4760List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
4761and exit.
4762
4763@end table
37166310 4764
fcc58db6
LC
4765@node Invoking guix size
4766@section Invoking @command{guix size}
4767
4768The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
4769disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
4770additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
4771single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
4772with Multiple Outputs}). These are the typical issues that
4773@command{guix size} can highlight.
4774
4775The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
4776or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
4777example:
4778
4779@example
4780$ guix size coreutils
4781store item total self
4782/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
4783/gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
4784/gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
4785/gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
4786/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
4787/gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
4788@end example
4789
4790@cindex closure
4791The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
4792Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
4793would be returned by:
4794
4795@example
4796$ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
4797@end example
4798
4799Here the output shows 3 columns next to store items. The first column,
4800labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
4801the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
4802dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
4803item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the item's size to the
4804space occupied by all the items listed here.
4805
4806In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
480770@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
4808large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
4809always available on the system anyway.)
4810
4811When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
4812store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
4813dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
4814-ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
4815Coreutils}).
4816
4817When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
4818reports information based on information about the available substitutes
4819(@pxref{Substitutes}). This allows it to profile disk usage of store
4820items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
4821
a8f996c6 4822The available options are:
fcc58db6
LC
4823
4824@table @option
4825
d490d06e
LC
4826@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4827Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
4828@xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
4829
a8f996c6
LC
4830@item --map-file=@var{file}
4831Write to @var{file} a graphical map of disk usage as a PNG file.
4832
4833For the example above, the map looks like this:
4834
4835@image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
4836produced by @command{guix size}}
4837
4838This option requires that
4839@uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
4840installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
4841the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
4842
fcc58db6
LC
4843@item --system=@var{system}
4844@itemx -s @var{system}
4845Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
4846
4847@end table
4848
88856916
LC
4849@node Invoking guix graph
4850@section Invoking @command{guix graph}
4851
4852@cindex DAG
4853Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
4854directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
4855mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command is
4856here to provide a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix
4857graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
4858@uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
4859directly to Graphviz's @command{dot} command, for instance. The general
4860syntax is:
4861
4862@example
4863guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4864@end example
4865
4866For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
4867package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
4868dependencies:
4869
4870@example
4871guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4872@end example
4873
4874The output looks like this:
4875
4876@image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4877
4878Nice little graph, no?
4879
4880But there's more than one graph! The one above is concise: it's the
4881graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
4882grep, etc. It's often useful to have such a concise graph, but
4883sometimes you want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
4884several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of details:
4885
4886@table @code
4887@item package
4888This is the default type, the one we used above. It shows the DAG of
4889package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
4890filters out many details.
4891
4892@item bag-emerged
4893This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
4894
4895For instance, the following command:
4896
4897@example
4898guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4899@end example
4900
4901... yields this bigger graph:
4902
4903@image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4904
4905At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
4906@var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4907
4908Now, note that the dependencies of those implicit inputs---that is, the
4909@dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
4910here, for conciseness.
4911
4912@item bag
4913Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
4914dependencies.
4915
38b92daa
LC
4916@item bag-with-origins
4917Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
4918
88856916
LC
4919@item derivations
4920This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
4921derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
4922the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
4923builds scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
4924
4925@end table
4926
4927All the above types correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
4928following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
4929
4930@table @code
4931@item references
4932This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
4933by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4934
4935If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
4936graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
4937@end table
4938
4939The available options are the following:
4940
4941@table @option
4942@item --type=@var{type}
4943@itemx -t @var{type}
4944Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
4945the values listed above.
4946
4947@item --list-types
4948List the supported graph types.
4c8f997a
LC
4949
4950@item --expression=@var{expr}
4951@itemx -e @var{expr}
4952Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4953
4954This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4955
4956@example
4957guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
4958@end example
88856916
LC
4959@end table
4960
4961
372c4bbc
DT
4962@node Invoking guix environment
4963@section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4964
f5fd4fd2 4965@cindex reproducible build environments
fe36d84e 4966@cindex development environments
372c4bbc
DT
4967The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4968creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4969package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4970packages, builds all of the necessary inputs, and creates a shell
4971environment to use them.
4972
4973The general syntax is:
4974
4975@example
4976guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4977@end example
4978
fe36d84e
LC
4979The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4980GNU@tie{}Guile:
372c4bbc
DT
4981
4982@example
4983guix environment guile
4984@end example
4985
4986If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4987automatically builds them. The new shell's environment is an augmented
4988version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4989It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4990added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4991environment in which the original environment variables have been unset,
50500f7c
LC
4992use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4993environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4994file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4995may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4996environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4997variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4998@file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4999@xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
5000details on Bash start-up files.}.
372c4bbc 5001
28de8d25
LC
5002@vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5003@command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5004variable in the shell it spaws. This allows users to, say, define a
5005specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5006(@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5007
5008@example
5009if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5010then
5011 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5012fi
5013@end example
5014
372c4bbc
DT
5015Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5016union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5017command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5018and Emacs are available:
5019
5020@example
5021guix environment guile emacs
5022@end example
5023
1de2fe95
DT
5024Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5025command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5026command from the rest of the arguments:
372c4bbc
DT
5027
5028@example
1de2fe95 5029guix environment guile -- make -j4
372c4bbc
DT
5030@end example
5031
fe36d84e
LC
5032In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5033packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5034runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5035NumPy:
5036
5037@example
1de2fe95 5038guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
fe36d84e
LC
5039@end example
5040
cc90fbbf
DT
5041Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5042additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5043are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5044@code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5045@code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5046added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5047packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5048the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5049additionally includes Git and strace:
5050
5051@example
5052guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
5053@end example
5054
f535dcbe
DT
5055Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5056possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5057using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
5058prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5059the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5060a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5061working directory are mounted:
5062
5063@example
5064guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5065@end example
5066
0f252e26 5067@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 5068The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
5069@end quotation
5070
fe36d84e 5071The available options are summarized below.
372c4bbc
DT
5072
5073@table @code
5074@item --expression=@var{expr}
5075@itemx -e @var{expr}
c9c282ce
DT
5076Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5077@var{expr} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5078
fe36d84e
LC
5079For example, running:
5080
5081@example
5082guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5083@end example
5084
5085starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5086PETSc package.
5087
c9c282ce
DT
5088Running:
5089
5090@example
5c2b2f00 5091guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
c9c282ce
DT
5092@end example
5093
5094starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
5095
372c4bbc
DT
5096@item --load=@var{file}
5097@itemx -l @var{file}
c9c282ce
DT
5098Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5099within @var{file} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5100
fe36d84e
LC
5101As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5102(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5103
5104@example
5105@verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5106@end example
5107
a54bd6d7
DT
5108@item --ad-hoc
5109Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5110@i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5111useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5112package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5113
5114For instance, the command:
5115
5116@example
1de2fe95 5117guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
a54bd6d7
DT
5118@end example
5119
5120runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5121available.
5122
417c39f1
LC
5123Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5124@code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl} but it is possible to ask for a
5125specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5126of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5127
cc90fbbf
DT
5128This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5129environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
5130as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
5131default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
5132that will be added to the environment directly.
5133
372c4bbc
DT
5134@item --pure
5135Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
5136This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
5137only contain package inputs.
5138
5139@item --search-paths
5140Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5141environment.
ce367ef3
LC
5142
5143@item --system=@var{system}
5144@itemx -s @var{system}
5145Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
f535dcbe
DT
5146
5147@item --container
5148@itemx -C
5149@cindex container
5150Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
56b6befb 5151directory outside the container is mapped inside the
f535dcbe
DT
5152container. Additionally, the spawned process runs as the current user
5153outside the container, but has root privileges in the context of the
5154container.
5155
5156@item --network
5157@itemx -N
5158For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5159Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5160device.
5161
5162@item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5163For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
5164as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
5165@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5166point in the container.
5167
5168The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5169home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5170directory:
5171
5172@example
5173guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5174@end example
5175
5c2b2f00 5176@item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
f535dcbe
DT
5177For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
5178as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
5179@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5180point in the container.
5181
5182The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5183home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
5184@file{/exchange} directory:
5185
5186@example
5187guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5188@end example
372c4bbc
DT
5189@end table
5190
5191It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
ccd7158d 5192build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
372c4bbc 5193
aff8ce7c
DT
5194@node Invoking guix publish
5195@section Invoking @command{guix publish}
5196
5197The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
8ce229fc
LC
5198their store with others, which can then use it as a substitute server
5199(@pxref{Substitutes}).
5200
5201When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
5202anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
5203that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
5204since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
5205the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
aff8ce7c
DT
5206
5207For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
5208their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
5209@command{guix publish} uses the system's signing key, which is only
5463fe51
LC
5210readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
5211@code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
aff8ce7c 5212
b18812b6
LC
5213The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
5214launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
5215guix archive}).
5216
aff8ce7c
DT
5217The general syntax is:
5218
5219@example
5220guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
5221@end example
5222
5223Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
5224spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
5225
5226@example
5227guix publish
5228@end example
5229
5230Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
5231archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
5232
5233@example
5234guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
5235@end example
5236
5237The following options are available:
5238
5239@table @code
5240@item --port=@var{port}
5241@itemx -p @var{port}
5242Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
5243
9e2292ef
LC
5244@item --listen=@var{host}
5245Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
5246accept connections from any interface.
5247
5463fe51
LC
5248@item --user=@var{user}
5249@itemx -u @var{user}
5250Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
5251server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
5252
aff8ce7c
DT
5253@item --repl[=@var{port}]
5254@itemx -r [@var{port}]
5255Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
8ce229fc
LC
5256Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
5257primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
aff8ce7c
DT
5258@end table
5259
1c52181f
LC
5260Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
5261add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
5262of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
5263@code{guix-publish-service}}).
5264
d23c20f1
LC
5265
5266@node Invoking guix challenge
5267@section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
5268
5269@cindex reproducible builds
5270@cindex verifiable builds
5271
5272Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
5273code it claims to build? Is this package's build process deterministic?
5274These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
5275answer.
5276
5277The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
5278server (@pxref{Substitutes}), you'd rather @emph{verify} that it
5279provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
5280is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
5281independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
5282bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
5283obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
5284
5285We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
5286the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
5287directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
5288etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
5289one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
5290@command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
5291mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
5292any given store item.
5293
5294The command's output looks like this:
5295
5296@smallexample
5297$ guix challenge --substitute-urls="http://hydra.gnu.org http://guix.example.org"
5298updating list of substitutes from 'http://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
5299updating list of substitutes from 'http://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
5300/gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
5301 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5302 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5303 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
5304/gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
5305 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
5306 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
5307 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
5308/gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
5309 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5310 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5311 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
5312@end smallexample
5313
5314@noindent
5315In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
5316determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
5317items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
5318all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
5319the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
5320
5321@cindex non-determinism, in package builds
5322As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
5323Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
5324case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
5325non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
5326various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
5327packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
5328sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
5329results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
5330by inode number. See @uref{http://reproducible.debian.net/howto/}, for
5331more information.
5332
5333To find out what's wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
5334these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
5335
5336@example
5337$ wget -q -O - http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
5338 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
043f4698 5339$ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
d23c20f1
LC
5340@end example
5341
5342This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
5343local build, and the files resulting from the build on
5344@code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
5345diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
5346works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
5347is @uref{http://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
5348visualize differences for all kinds of files.
5349
5350Once you've done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
5351to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
5352hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
5353to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process, one that
5354involves not just Guix but a large part of the free software community.
5355In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
5356the problem.
5357
5358If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
5359whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
5360same build result as you did with:
5361
5362@example
5363$ guix challenge @var{package}
5364@end example
5365
5366@noindent
5367... where @var{package} is a package specification such as
5368@code{guile-2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
5369
5370The general syntax is:
5371
5372@example
5373guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
5374@end example
5375
5376The one option that matters is:
5377
5378@table @code
5379
5380@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5381Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
5382URLs to compare to.
5383
5384@end table
5385
5386
32efa254
DT
5387@node Invoking guix container
5388@section Invoking @command{guix container}
5389@cindex container
5390
5391@quotation Note
5392As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
5393is subject to radical change in the future.
5394@end quotation
5395
5396The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
5397running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
46c36586 5398``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
32efa254
DT
5399(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
5400(@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
5401
5402The general syntax is:
5403
5404@example
5405guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
5406@end example
5407
5408@var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
5409@var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
5410
5411The following actions are available:
5412
5413@table @code
5414@item exec
5415Execute a command within the context of a running container.
5416
5417The syntax is:
5418
5419@example
5420guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
5421@end example
5422
5423@var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
5424@var{program} specifies an executable file name within the container's
5425root file system. @var{arguments} are the additional options that will
5426be passed to @var{program}.
5427
5428The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
5429GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
5430process ID is 9001:
5431
5432@example
5433guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
5434@end example
5435
5436Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
5437must be the container's PID 1 or one of its child processes.
5438
5439@end table
5440
a1ba8475
LC
5441@c *********************************************************************
5442@node GNU Distribution
5443@chapter GNU Distribution
5444
3ca2731c 5445@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 5446@cindex GuixSD
3ca2731c
LC
5447Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
5448free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
a1ba8475 5449@url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
3ca2731c 5450users of that software}.}. The
35ed9306
LC
5451distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
5452but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
5453an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
3ca2731c 5454between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
4705641f 5455System Distribution, or GuixSD.
35ed9306
LC
5456
5457The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
5458Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
5459list of available packages can be browsed
093ae1be 5460@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
d03bb653 5461running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
a1ba8475
LC
5462
5463@example
e49951eb 5464guix package --list-available
a1ba8475
LC
5465@end example
5466
35ed9306 5467Our goal has been to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
401c53c4
LC
5468Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
5469tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
5470tools that help users exert that freedom.
5471
3ca2731c 5472Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
c320011d
LC
5473
5474@table @code
5475
5476@item x86_64-linux
5477Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
5478
5479@item i686-linux
5480Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
5481
aa1e1947 5482@item armhf-linux
aa725117 5483ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
aa1e1947
MW
5484using the EABI hard-float ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
5485
c320011d
LC
5486@item mips64el-linux
5487little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
5488n32 application binary interface (ABI), and Linux-Libre kernel.
5489
5490@end table
5491
4705641f 5492GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
3ca2731c 5493
c320011d
LC
5494@noindent
5495For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
5496@xref{Porting}.
5497
401c53c4 5498@menu
5af6de3e 5499* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 5500* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
91ef73d4 5501* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
05962f29 5502* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
401c53c4 5503* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
da7cabd4 5504* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
401c53c4 5505* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
8b315a6d 5506* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
401c53c4
LC
5507@end menu
5508
5509Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
081145cf 5510to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
401c53c4 5511
5af6de3e
LC
5512@node System Installation
5513@section System Installation
5514
3ca2731c
LC
5515@cindex Guix System Distribution
5516This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution
5517on a machine. The Guix package manager can
35ed9306
LC
5518also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
5519@pxref{Installation}.
5af6de3e
LC
5520
5521@ifinfo
5522@c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
5523@c installation image.
5524You're reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
5525how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6621cdb6 5526link that follows: @pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An Introduction}. Hit
5af6de3e
LC
5527@kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
5528@end ifinfo
5529
8aaaae38
LC
5530@subsection Limitations
5531
4705641f 5532As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
3ca2731c 5533not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
8aaaae38
LC
5534features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
5535respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
5536is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
5537more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
4705641f 5538to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
8aaaae38
LC
5539also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
5540of it (@pxref{Installation}).
5541
5542Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
5543noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
5544
5545@itemize
5546@item
5547The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
5548requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
5549get a feel of what that means.)
5550
5551@item
093ae1be
LC
5552The system does not yet provide full GNOME and KDE desktops. Xfce and
5553Enlightenment are available though, if graphical desktop environments
5554are your thing, as well as a number of X11 window managers.
8aaaae38
LC
5555
5556@item
dbcb0ab1 5557Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
8aaaae38
LC
5558
5559@item
5560Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
5561(@pxref{Services}).
5562
5563@item
093ae1be 5564More than 2,000 packages are available, but you may
8aaaae38
LC
5565occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
5566@end itemize
5567
5568You've been warned. But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
5569to report issues (and success stories!), and join us in improving it.
5570@xref{Contributing}, for more info.
5af6de3e
LC
5571
5572@subsection USB Stick Installation
5573
5574An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
4705641f 5575@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
5af6de3e
LC
5576where @var{system} is one of:
5577
5578@table @code
5579@item x86_64-linux
5580for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
5581
5582@item i686-linux
5583for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
5584@end table
5585
5586This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
5587installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
5588USB stick.
5589
5590To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
5591
5592@enumerate
5593@item
5594Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
5595
5596@example
4705641f 5597xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
5af6de3e
LC
5598@end example
5599
5600@item
5601Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more in your machine, and determine
5602its device name. Assuming that USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
5603copy the image with:
5604
5605@example
4705641f 5606dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
5af6de3e
LC
5607@end example
5608
5609Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
5610@end enumerate
5611
5612Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
5613the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
5614menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
5615
5616@subsection Preparing for Installation
5617
5618Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
5619end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
5620be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
5621browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An
ae7ffa9e
LC
5622Introduction}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
5623which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste
5624it with the middle button.
5af6de3e
LC
5625
5626To install the system, you would:
5627
5628@enumerate
5629
5630@item
235cba85
LC
5631Configure the network, by running:
5632
5633@example
5634ifconfig eno1 up && dhclient eno1
5635@end example
5636
5637to get an automatically assigned IP address from the wired
152dd61c 5638network interface controller@footnote{
95c559c1
LC
5639@c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
5640The name @code{eno1} is for the first on-board Ethernet controller. The
5641interface name for an Ethernet controller that is in the first slot of
5642the first PCI bus, for instance, would be @code{enp1s0}. Use
235cba85 5643@command{ifconfig -a} to list all the available network interfaces.},
95c559c1 5644or using the @command{ifconfig} command.
5af6de3e
LC
5645
5646The system automatically loads drivers for your network interface
5647controllers.
5648
5649Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
5650image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
5651
5652@item
316d65be
LC
5653Unless this has already been done, you must partition, and then format
5654the target partition.
5af6de3e 5655
7ab44369
LC
5656Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
5657reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
5658Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
5659@command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands.
5660
dd816355
LF
5661Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
5662@code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, if your
5663@code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
5664@code{'label}, as do the example configurations found on the USB
5665installation image under @file{/etc/configuration} (@pxref{Using the
5666Configuration System}).
5667
316d65be
LC
5668@c FIXME: Uncomment this once GRUB fully supports encrypted roots.
5669@c A typical command sequence may be:
5670@c
5671@c @example
5672@c # fdisk /dev/sdX
5673@c @dots{} Create partitions etc.@dots{}
5674@c # cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sdX1
5675@c # cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sdX1 my-partition
5676@c # mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
5677@c @end example
6d6e6281 5678
5af6de3e 5679The installation image includes Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU
b419c7f5
LC
5680Parted User Manual}), @command{fdisk}, Cryptsetup/LUKS for disk
5681encryption, and e2fsprogs, the suite of tools to manipulate
5682ext2/ext3/ext4 file systems.
5af6de3e 5683
83a17b62
LC
5684@item
5685Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}.
5686
5687@item
dd17bc38 5688Lastly, run @code{herd start cow-store /mnt}.
83a17b62
LC
5689
5690This will make @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added
5691to it during the installation phase will be written to the target disk
5692rather than kept in memory.
5693
5af6de3e
LC
5694@end enumerate
5695
5af6de3e
LC
5696
5697@subsection Proceeding with the Installation
5698
5699With the target partitions ready, you now have to edit a file and
5700provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
5701that end, the installation system comes with two text editors: GNU nano
5702(@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), and GNU Zile, an Emacs clone.
5703It is better to store that file on the target root file system, say, as
5704@file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}.
5705
dd51caac
LC
5706@xref{Using the Configuration System}, for examples of operating system
5707configurations. These examples are available under
5708@file{/etc/configuration} in the installation image, so you can copy
5709them and use them as a starting point for your own configuration.
5af6de3e 5710
dd51caac
LC
5711Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
5712be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
5713under @file{/mnt}):
5af6de3e
LC
5714
5715@example
5716guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
5717@end example
5718
5719@noindent
5720This will copy all the necessary files, and install GRUB on
5721@file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6621cdb6 5722more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
5af6de3e
LC
5723downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
5724
1bd4e6db
LC
5725Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
5726@command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
5727in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
5728initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
5729unless your configuration specifies otherwise
5730(@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
5731
5732Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
5af6de3e
LC
5733@file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
5734good.
5735
5736@subsection Building the Installation Image
5737
5738The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
5739system} command, specifically:
5740
5741@example
8a225c66 5742guix system disk-image --image-size=850MiB gnu/system/install.scm
5af6de3e
LC
5743@end example
5744
5745@xref{Invoking guix system}, for more information. See
5746@file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree for more information
5747about the installation image.
5748
cf4a9129
LC
5749@node System Configuration
5750@section System Configuration
b208a005 5751
cf4a9129 5752@cindex system configuration
3ca2731c 5753The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
cf4a9129
LC
5754mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
5755configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
5756locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
5757a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
91ef73d4 5758
cf4a9129
LC
5759One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
5760control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
5761makes it possible to roll-back to a previous system instantiation,
5762should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
5763one is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
5764across different machines, or at different points in time, without
5765having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
5766the system's own tools.
5767@c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
91ef73d4 5768
cf4a9129
LC
5769This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
5770administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
5771instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
5772instance to support new system services.
91ef73d4 5773
cf4a9129
LC
5774@menu
5775* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
7313a52e 5776* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
cf4a9129 5777* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
510f9d86 5778* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
cf4a9129 5779* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 5780* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
cf4a9129 5781* Services:: Specifying system services.
0ae8c15a 5782* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
efb5e833 5783* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 5784* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
fd1b1fa2 5785* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
88faf933 5786* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
cf4a9129 5787* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 5788* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
cf4a9129
LC
5789* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
5790@end menu
91ef73d4 5791
cf4a9129
LC
5792@node Using the Configuration System
5793@subsection Using the Configuration System
64d76fa6 5794
cf4a9129
LC
5795The operating system is configured by providing an
5796@code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
5797the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
5798simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
5799kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
91ef73d4 5800
cf4a9129
LC
5801@findex operating-system
5802@lisp
dd51caac 5803@include os-config-bare-bones.texi
cf4a9129 5804@end lisp
401c53c4 5805
cf4a9129
LC
5806This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
5807above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
5808Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
5809which case they get a default value.
e7f34eb0 5810
5d94ac51
LC
5811Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
5812(@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
5813fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
5814@command{guix system}.
5815
5816@unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
5817
cf4a9129 5818@vindex %base-packages
5d94ac51
LC
5819The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
5820on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
5821environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
5822(@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
5823provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
5824tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
5825the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
5826etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
5827packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
e7f34eb0 5828
f6c9fb1b
LC
5829@findex specification->package
5830Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
5831the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
5832diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
5833needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
5834@code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
5835the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
5836module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
5837version:
5838
5839@lisp
5840(use-modules (gnu packages))
5841
5842(operating-system
5843 ;; ...
5844 (packages (append (map specification->package
5845 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg-2.0"))
5846 %base-packages)))
5847@end lisp
5848
5d94ac51
LC
5849@unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
5850
cf4a9129
LC
5851@vindex %base-services
5852The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
5853available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
5854The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
5855addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
cd6f6c22
LC
5856daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
5857@code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
cf4a9129
LC
5858@code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
5859right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
cd6f6c22
LC
5860generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
5861
5862@cindex customization, of services
5863@findex modify-services
5864Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
5865customize them. For instance, to change the configuration of
5866@code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty (the console log-in), you may write the
5867following instead of @var{%base-services}:
5868
5869@lisp
5870(modify-services %base-services
5871 (guix-service-type config =>
5872 (guix-configuration
5873 (inherit config)
5874 (use-substitutes? #f)
5875 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-outputs"))))
5876 (mingetty-service-type config =>
5877 (mingetty-configuration
5878 (inherit config)
5879 (motd (plain-file "motd" "Hi there!")))))
5880@end lisp
5881
5882@noindent
5883The effect here is to change the options passed to @command{guix-daemon}
5884when it is started, as well as the ``message of the day'' that appears
5885when logging in at the console. @xref{Service Reference,
5886@code{modify-services}}, for more on that.
a1ba8475 5887
dd51caac 5888The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with the X11 display
cd6f6c22 5889server, a desktop environment, network management, power management, and
dd51caac
LC
5890more, would look like this:
5891
5892@lisp
5893@include os-config-desktop.texi
5894@end lisp
5895
5896@xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
efb5e833
LC
5897@var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
5898information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
dd51caac 5899
5d94ac51
LC
5900Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
5901you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
5902procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
5903Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
5904following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
5905@var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
5906
5907@example
5908(remove (lambda (service)
5909 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
5910 %desktop-services)
5911@end example
5912
5913@unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
5914
5915Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
5916is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
cf4a9129
LC
5917file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
5918instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
65797bff
LC
5919entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
5920
5921The normal way to change the system's configuration is by updating this
5922file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
5923have to touch files in @command{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
5924system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
5925fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
5926but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
5927system, should you ever need to.
5928
5929@cindex roll-back, of the operating system
5930Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
5931reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
5932modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
5933an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
5934something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
5935@command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
5936generations available on disk.
b81e1947 5937
5d94ac51
LC
5938@unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
5939
cf4a9129
LC
5940At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
5941is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
5942Monad}):
b81e1947 5943
cf4a9129
LC
5944@deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
5945Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
5946object (@pxref{Derivations}).
b81e1947 5947
cf4a9129
LC
5948The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
5949the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
5950instantiate @var{os}.
5951@end deffn
b81e1947 5952
5d94ac51
LC
5953This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
5954with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
5955guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
5956
5957
7313a52e
LC
5958@node operating-system Reference
5959@subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
5960
5961This section summarizes all the options available in
5962@code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
5963System}).
5964
5965@deftp {Data Type} operating-system
5966This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
5967By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
5968configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
5969
5970@table @asis
5971@item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
fbb25e56 5972The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
7313a52e
LC
5973only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
5974possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
5975
ee2a6304
LC
5976@item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5977List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
5978the kernel's command-line---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
5979
7313a52e 5980@item @code{bootloader}
88faf933 5981The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
7313a52e
LC
5982
5983@item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
5984A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
5985the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
5986
f34c56be
LC
5987@item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
5988@cindex firmware
5989List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
5990
5991The default includes firmware needed for Atheros-based WiFi devices
5992(Linux-libre module @code{ath9k}.)
5993
7313a52e
LC
5994@item @code{host-name}
5995The host name.
5996
5997@item @code{hosts-file}
5998@cindex hosts file
24e02c28 5999A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
7313a52e 6000@file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
24e02c28 6001Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
7313a52e
LC
6002@code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
6003
6004@item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6005A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
6006
6007@item @code{file-systems}
6008A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
6009
6010@item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6011@cindex swap devices
6012A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
6013(@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6014For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
6015
bf87f38a 6016@item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
7313a52e
LC
6017@itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
6018List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
6019
6020@item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
6021A monadic list of pairs of target file name and files. These are the
6022files that will be used as skeletons as new accounts are created.
6023
6024For instance, a valid value may look like this:
6025
6026@example
6027(mlet %store-monad ((bashrc (text-file "bashrc" "\
6028 export PATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/bin")))
6029 (return `((".bashrc" ,bashrc))))
6030@end example
6031
6032@item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
6033A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
6034what displayed when users log in on a text console.
6035
6036@item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
6037The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
6038at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
6039
6040The default set includes core utilities, but it is good practice to
6041install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
6042package}).
6043
6044@item @code{timezone}
6045A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
6046
598e19dc
LC
6047@item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
6048The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
6049Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
6050
6051@item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
6052The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
6053run time. @xref{Locales}.
7313a52e 6054
34760ae7
LC
6055@item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
6056The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
6057to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
6058considerations that justify this option.
6059
996ed739
LC
6060@item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
6061Configuration of libc's name service switch (NSS)---a
6062@code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
6063details.
6064
7313a52e 6065@item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
28d939af 6066A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
7313a52e
LC
6067
6068@item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
6069@cindex PAM
6070@cindex pluggable authentication modules
6071Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
6072@c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
6073
6074@item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
6075List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
6076@xref{Setuid Programs}.
6077
f5a9ffa0
AK
6078@item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
6079@cindex sudoers file
84765839
LC
6080The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
6081(@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
7313a52e
LC
6082
6083This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
6084they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
6085is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
6086@code{sudo}.
6087
6088@end table
6089@end deftp
6090
cf4a9129
LC
6091@node File Systems
6092@subsection File Systems
b81e1947 6093
cf4a9129
LC
6094The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
6095@code{file-systems} field of the operating system's declaration
6096(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
6097using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
b81e1947
LC
6098
6099@example
cf4a9129
LC
6100(file-system
6101 (mount-point "/home")
6102 (device "/dev/sda3")
6103 (type "ext4"))
b81e1947
LC
6104@end example
6105
cf4a9129
LC
6106As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
6107above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
b81e1947 6108
cf4a9129
LC
6109@deftp {Data Type} file-system
6110Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
6111contain the following members:
5ff3c4b8 6112
cf4a9129
LC
6113@table @asis
6114@item @code{type}
6115This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
6116@code{"ext4"}.
5ff3c4b8 6117
cf4a9129
LC
6118@item @code{mount-point}
6119This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
b81e1947 6120
cf4a9129
LC
6121@item @code{device}
6122This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
6123of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
6124field described below.
401c53c4 6125
cf4a9129
LC
6126@item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
6127This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
6128interpreted.
401c53c4 6129
cf4a9129
LC
6130When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
6131interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
6132is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
6133@code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
da7cabd4 6134
661a1d79
LC
6135UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
6136@command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form, like this:
6137
6138@example
6139(file-system
6140 (mount-point "/home")
6141 (type "ext4")
6142 (title 'uuid)
6143 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
6144@end example
6145
cf4a9129 6146The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
661a1d79
LC
6147partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
6148name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
6149@file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
6150result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
6151by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
6152mounted.}.
da7cabd4 6153
5f86a66e
LC
6154However, when a file system's source is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
6155Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
6156device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
6157@code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
6158the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
6159corresponding device mapping established.
6160
cf4a9129
LC
6161@item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
6162This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
2c071ce9
LC
6163include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
6164access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
6165bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
da7cabd4 6166
cf4a9129
LC
6167@item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
6168This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
da7cabd4 6169
be21979d
LC
6170@item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
6171This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
6172the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
6173an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
6174is not automatically mounted.
6175
cf4a9129
LC
6176@item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
6177This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
6178booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
6179initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
6180instance, for the root file system.
da7cabd4 6181
cf4a9129
LC
6182@item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
6183This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
6184errors before being mounted.
f9cc8971 6185
4e469051
LC
6186@item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
6187When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
6188
e51710d1
LC
6189@item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
6190This is a list of @code{<file-system>} objects representing file systems
6191that must be mounted before (and unmounted after) this one.
6192
6193As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
6194a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
6195@file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
6196
cf4a9129
LC
6197@end table
6198@end deftp
da7cabd4 6199
a69576ea
LC
6200The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
6201variables.
6202
6203@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
6204These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
cc0e575a 6205such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
3392ce5d
LC
6206below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
6207these.
a69576ea
LC
6208@end defvr
6209
7f239fd3
LC
6210@defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
6211This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
6212@dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
6213functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
6214Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
6215@command{xterm}.
6216@end defvr
6217
db17ae5c
LC
6218@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
6219This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
6220memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
6221@code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6222@end defvr
6223
3392ce5d
LC
6224@defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
6225This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
6226@file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
6227@code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
6228running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
6229
6230The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
6231read-write in its own ``name space.''
6232@end defvr
6233
a69576ea
LC
6234@defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
6235The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
6236executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
6237@code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6238@end defvr
6239
6240@defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
6241The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
6242and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
6243@code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6244@end defvr
6245
510f9d86
LC
6246@node Mapped Devices
6247@subsection Mapped Devices
6248
6249@cindex device mapping
6250@cindex mapped devices
6251The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
6252such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
6253with additional processing over the data that flows through
6254it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
6255concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
6256to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
6257operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
6258devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
6259(@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
6260typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
6261device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
6262
6263Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form:
6264
6265@example
6266(mapped-device
6267 (source "/dev/sda3")
6268 (target "home")
6269 (type luks-device-mapping))
6270@end example
6271
6272@noindent
6273@cindex disk encryption
6274@cindex LUKS
6275This example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
6276@file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
6277@url{http://code.google.com/p/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
6278standard mechanism for disk encryption. The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
6279device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
6280declaration (@pxref{File Systems}). The @code{mapped-device} form is
6281detailed below.
6282
6283@deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
6284Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
6285the system boots up.
6286
9cb426b8
LC
6287@table @code
6288@item source
510f9d86
LC
6289This string specifies the name of the block device to be mapped, such as
6290@code{"/dev/sda3"}.
6291
9cb426b8 6292@item target
510f9d86
LC
6293This string specifies the name of the mapping to be established. For
6294example, specifying @code{"my-partition"} will lead to the creation of
6295the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
6296
9cb426b8 6297@item type
510f9d86
LC
6298This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
6299@var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
6300@end table
6301@end deftp
6302
6303@defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
6304This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
6305command, from the same-named package. This relies on the
6306@code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
6307@end defvr
6308
cf4a9129
LC
6309@node User Accounts
6310@subsection User Accounts
ee85f3db 6311
9bea87a5
LC
6312User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
6313@code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
6314@code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
ee85f3db 6315
cf4a9129
LC
6316@example
6317(user-account
6318 (name "alice")
6319 (group "users")
24e752c0
LC
6320 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
6321 "audio" ;sound card
6322 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
6323 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
cf4a9129
LC
6324 (comment "Bob's sister")
6325 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
6326@end example
25083588 6327
9bea87a5
LC
6328When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
6329the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
6330the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
6331properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
6332directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
6333reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
6334as declared.
6335
cf4a9129
LC
6336@deftp {Data Type} user-account
6337Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
6338be specified:
ee85f3db 6339
cf4a9129
LC
6340@table @asis
6341@item @code{name}
6342The name of the user account.
ee85f3db 6343
cf4a9129
LC
6344@item @code{group}
6345This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
6346this account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6347
cf4a9129
LC
6348@item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
6349Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
6350account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6351
cf4a9129
LC
6352@item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
6353This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
6354latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
6355account is created.
ee85f3db 6356
cf4a9129
LC
6357@item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
6358A comment about the account, such as the account's owner full name.
c8c871d1 6359
cf4a9129
LC
6360@item @code{home-directory}
6361This is the name of the home directory for the account.
ee85f3db 6362
cf4a9129
LC
6363@item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
6364This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
6365the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
ee85f3db 6366
cf4a9129
LC
6367@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6368This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
6369account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
6370graphical login managers do not list them.
ee85f3db 6371
1bd4e6db 6372@anchor{user-account-password}
cf4a9129 6373@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
eb59595c
LC
6374You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
6375passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
9bea87a5
LC
6376users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
6377@command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
6378reconfiguration.
eb59595c
LC
6379
6380If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
6381this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
5d1f1177
LC
6382@xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
6383on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
eb59595c 6384Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
c8c871d1 6385
cf4a9129
LC
6386@end table
6387@end deftp
ee85f3db 6388
cf4a9129 6389User group declarations are even simpler:
ee85f3db 6390
cf4a9129
LC
6391@example
6392(user-group (name "students"))
6393@end example
ee85f3db 6394
cf4a9129
LC
6395@deftp {Data Type} user-group
6396This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
af8a56b8 6397
cf4a9129
LC
6398@table @asis
6399@item @code{name}
6400The group's name.
ee85f3db 6401
cf4a9129
LC
6402@item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
6403The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
6404automatically allocated when the group is created.
ee85f3db 6405
c8fa3426
LC
6406@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6407This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
6408System groups have low numerical IDs.
6409
cf4a9129
LC
6410@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
6411What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
6412@code{#f}, this field specifies the group's password.
ee85f3db 6413
cf4a9129
LC
6414@end table
6415@end deftp
401c53c4 6416
cf4a9129
LC
6417For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
6418expect:
401c53c4 6419
cf4a9129
LC
6420@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
6421This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
6422to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
6423``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
6424specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
6425@end defvr
401c53c4 6426
bf87f38a
LC
6427@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
6428This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
6429find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
6430
6431Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
6432special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
6433@end defvr
6434
598e19dc
LC
6435@node Locales
6436@subsection Locales
6437
6438@cindex locale
6439A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
6440and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6441Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
b2636518 6442@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
598e19dc
LC
6443@code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
6444cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
6445
6446@cindex locale definition
6447Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
6448using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
6449(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
6450
6451That locale must be among the @dfn{locale definitions} that are known to
6452the system---and these are specified in the @code{locale-definitions}
6453slot of @code{operating-system}. The default value includes locale
c4847f49 6454definitions for some widely used locales, but not for all the available
598e19dc
LC
6455locales, in order to save space.
6456
6457If the locale specified in the @code{locale} field is not among the
6458definitions listed in @code{locale-definitions}, @command{guix system}
6459raises an error. In that case, you should add the locale definition to
6460the @code{locale-definitions} field. For instance, to add the North
6461Frisian locale for Germany, the value of that field may be:
6462
6463@example
6464(cons (locale-definition
6465 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
6466 %default-locale-definitions)
6467@end example
6468
6469Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
6470list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
6471
6472@example
6473(list (locale-definition
6474 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
6475 (charset "EUC-JP")))
6476@end example
6477
5c3c1427
LC
6478@vindex LOCPATH
6479The compiled locale definitions are available at
46bd6edd
LC
6480@file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
6481version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
6482by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
6483@code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
5c3c1427
LC
6484@code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6485
598e19dc
LC
6486The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
6487locale)} module. Details are given below.
6488
6489@deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
6490This is the data type of a locale definition.
6491
6492@table @asis
6493
6494@item @code{name}
6495The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6496Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
6497
6498@item @code{source}
6499The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
6500@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
6501
6502@item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
6503The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
6504@uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
6505IANA}.
6506
6507@end table
6508@end deftp
6509
6510@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
b2636518
LC
6511An arbitrary list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
6512value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
598e19dc 6513declarations.
b2636518
LC
6514
6515@cindex locale name
6516@cindex normalized codeset in locale names
6517These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
6518that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
6519normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
6520instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
6521@code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
598e19dc 6522@end defvr
401c53c4 6523
34760ae7
LC
6524@subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
6525
6526@cindex incompatibility, of locale data
6527@code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
6528to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
6529declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
6530care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
6531locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
6532another.
6533
6534@c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
6535@c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
6536For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
6537read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
6538@emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
6539data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
6540the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
6541Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
6542all, the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
6543data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
6544programs will not abort.
6545
6546The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
6547choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
6548be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
6549used to build the system-wide locale data.
6550
6551Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
6552and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
6553@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6554
6555Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
6556@file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
6557actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
6558it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
6559administrator can specify several libc packages in the
6560@code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
6561
6562@example
6563(use-package-modules base)
6564
6565(operating-system
6566 ;; @dots{}
6567 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
6568@end example
6569
6570This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
6571both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
6572@file{/run/current-system/locale}.
6573
6574
cf4a9129
LC
6575@node Services
6576@subsection Services
401c53c4 6577
cf4a9129
LC
6578@cindex system services
6579An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
6580listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
6581Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
6582when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
d8b94dbd
LC
6583configuring network access.
6584
dd17bc38
AK
6585Services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd (@pxref{Introduction,,,
6586shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). On a running system, the
6587@command{herd} command allows you to list the available services, show
6588their status, start and stop them, or do other specific operations
6589(@pxref{Jump Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
d8b94dbd
LC
6590
6591@example
dd17bc38 6592# herd status
d8b94dbd
LC
6593@end example
6594
6595The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
dd17bc38 6596services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
d8b94dbd
LC
6597service:
6598
6599@example
dd17bc38 6600# herd doc nscd
d8b94dbd
LC
6601Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
6602@end example
6603
6604The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
6605have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
6606the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
6607
6608@example
dd17bc38 6609# herd stop nscd
d8b94dbd 6610Service nscd has been stopped.
dd17bc38 6611# herd restart xorg-server
d8b94dbd
LC
6612Service xorg-server has been stopped.
6613Service xorg-server has been started.
6614@end example
401c53c4 6615
cf4a9129 6616The following sections document the available services, starting with
d8b94dbd
LC
6617the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
6618declaration.
401c53c4 6619
cf4a9129
LC
6620@menu
6621* Base Services:: Essential system services.
6622* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
6623* X Window:: Graphical display.
fe1a39d3 6624* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
105369a4 6625* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 6626* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
58724c48 6627* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 6628* Various Services:: Other services.
cf4a9129 6629@end menu
401c53c4 6630
cf4a9129
LC
6631@node Base Services
6632@subsubsection Base Services
a1ba8475 6633
cf4a9129
LC
6634The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
6635services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
6636this module are listed below.
401c53c4 6637
cf4a9129 6638@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
31771497
LC
6639This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
6640and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
cf4a9129
LC
6641expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
6642libc's name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
6643more.
401c53c4 6644
cf4a9129
LC
6645This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
6646@code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
6647system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
6648this:
401c53c4 6649
cf4a9129 6650@example
fa1e31b8 6651(cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
cf4a9129
LC
6652@end example
6653@end defvr
401c53c4 6654
be1c2c54 6655@deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
cf4a9129
LC
6656Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
6657@end deffn
401c53c4 6658
66e4f01c
LC
6659@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
6660Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
6661@code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
6662other things.
cf4a9129 6663@end deffn
401c53c4 6664
66e4f01c
LC
6665@deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
6666This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
6667implements console log-in.
6668
6669@table @asis
6670
6671@item @code{tty}
6672The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
6673
6674@item @code{motd}
6675A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
6676
6677@item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
6678When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
f9b9a033 6679which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
66e4f01c
LC
6680user name and password must be entered to log in.
6681
6682@item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
6683This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
6684is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
6685the name of the log-in program.
6686
6687@item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
6688When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
6689will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
6690
6691@item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
6692The Mingetty package to use.
6693
6694@end table
6695@end deftp
6696
6454b333
LC
6697@cindex name service cache daemon
6698@cindex nscd
be1c2c54 6699@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
4aee6e60 6700 [#:name-services '()]
b893f1ae
LC
6701Return a service that runs libc's name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
6702given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
6703Service Switch}, for an example.
cf4a9129 6704@end deffn
401c53c4 6705
6454b333
LC
6706@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
6707This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
6708by @code{nscd-service}. This uses the caches defined by
6709@var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
6710@end defvr
6711
6712@deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
6713This is the type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
6714configuration.
6715
6716@table @asis
6717
b893f1ae
LC
6718@item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
6719List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
6720the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
6721
6722@item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
6723Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
6724command.
6725
6454b333
LC
6726@item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
6727Name of nscd's log file. This is where debugging output goes when
6728@code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
6729
6730@item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
6731Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean more
6732debugging output is logged.
6733
6734@item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
6735List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
6736below.
6737
6738@end table
6739@end deftp
6740
6741@deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
6742Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
6743
6744@table @asis
6745
6746@item @code{database}
6747This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
6748Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
6749@code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
6750(@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6751
6752@item @code{positive-time-to-live}
6753@itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
6754A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
6755negative lookup result remains in cache.
6756
6757@item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
6758Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
6759@var{database}.
6760
6761For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
6762instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
6763them into account.
6764
6765@item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
6766Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
6767
6768@item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
6769Whether the cache should be shared among users.
6770
6771@item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
6772Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
6773
6774@c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
6775@c settings, so leave them out.
6776
6777@end table
6778@end deftp
6779
6780@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
6781List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
6782@code{nscd-configuration} (see above.)
6783
6784It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
6785lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
6786resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
6787privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
6788external name servers do not even need to be queried.
6789@end defvr
6790
6791
be1c2c54 6792@deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service [#:config-file #f]
1bb76f75
AK
6793Return a service that runs @code{syslogd}. If configuration file name
6794@var{config-file} is not specified, use some reasonable default
cf4a9129
LC
6795settings.
6796@end deffn
401c53c4 6797
0adfe95a
LC
6798@anchor{guix-configuration-type}
6799@deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
6800This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
6801@xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
6802
6803@table @asis
6804@item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
6805The Guix package to use.
401c53c4 6806
0adfe95a
LC
6807@item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
6808Name of the group for build user accounts.
401c53c4 6809
0adfe95a
LC
6810@item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
6811Number of build user accounts to create.
401c53c4 6812
0adfe95a
LC
6813@item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
6814Whether to authorize the substitute key for @code{hydra.gnu.org}
6815(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6816
6817@item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
6818Whether to use substitutes.
6819
b0b9f6e0
LC
6820@item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
6821The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
6822
0adfe95a
LC
6823@item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
6824List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
6825
6826@item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
6827@itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
6828The lsof and lsh packages to use.
6829
6830@end table
6831@end deftp
6832
6833@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
6834Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
6835@var{config}.
cf4a9129 6836@end deffn
a1ba8475 6837
be1c2c54 6838@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
cf4a9129
LC
6839Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
6840@end deffn
401c53c4 6841
be1c2c54 6842@deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{file}
5eca9459
AK
6843Return a service to load console keymap from @var{file} using
6844@command{loadkeys} command.
6845@end deffn
6846
8664cc88
LC
6847@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service-type [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
6848 [#:options]
6849Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
6850command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
6851notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
6852uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
6853
6854This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
6855@end deffn
6856
1c52181f
LC
6857@anchor{guix-publish-service}
6858@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
6859 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
6860Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
6861and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
6862
6863This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
6864created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
6865archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
6866@end deffn
6867
a69576ea 6868
cf4a9129
LC
6869@node Networking Services
6870@subsubsection Networking Services
401c53c4 6871
fa1e31b8 6872The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
cf4a9129 6873the network interface.
a1ba8475 6874
a023cca8 6875@cindex DHCP, networking service
be1c2c54 6876@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
a023cca8
LC
6877Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
6878Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
6879@end deffn
6880
be1c2c54 6881@deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
cf4a9129
LC
6882 [#:gateway #f] [#:name-services @code{'()}]
6883Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
6884@var{gateway} is true, it must be a string specifying the default network
6885gateway.
6886@end deffn
8b315a6d 6887
b7d0c494 6888@cindex wicd
87f40011 6889@cindex network management
be1c2c54 6890@deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
87f40011
LC
6891Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
6892management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
6893
6894This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
6895several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
6896@command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
6897and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
b7d0c494
MW
6898@end deffn
6899
c0a9589d
SB
6900@cindex NetworkManager
6901@deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
6902 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
6903Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
6904that attempting to keep active network connectivity when available.
6905@end deffn
6906
be1c2c54 6907@deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
63854bcb
LC
6908 [#:name-service @var{%ntp-servers}]
6909Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
6910@uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
6911keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
6912@end deffn
6913
6914@defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
6915List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
6916@end defvr
6917
375c6108
LC
6918@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
6919Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
6920networking daemon.
8b315a6d 6921
375c6108 6922The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
6331bde7
LC
6923@var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
6924and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
6925@command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
6926@end deffn
6927
24a8ef3b 6928@cindex hidden service
6331bde7
LC
6929@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
6930Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
6931@var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
6932
6933@example
24a8ef3b
LC
6934 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
6935 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
6331bde7
LC
6936@end example
6937
6938In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
6939port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
6940
6629099a
LC
6941This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
6942the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
6331bde7
LC
6943service.
6944
6945See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
6946project's documentation} for more information.
cf4a9129 6947@end deffn
8b315a6d 6948
be1c2c54 6949@deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
4627a464
LC
6950 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
6951 [#:extra-settings ""]
6952Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
6953acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
6954
6955The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
6956specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
6957local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
6958come from any networking interface.
6959
6960In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
6961configuration file.
6962@end deffn
6963
f4391bec 6964Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following service.
8b315a6d 6965
be1c2c54 6966@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
5833bf33 6967 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
cf4a9129
LC
6968 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
6969 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
6970 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
21cc905a 6971 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
cf4a9129
LC
6972Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
6973@var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
6974only by root.
72e25e35 6975
5833bf33
DP
6976When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
6977controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
6978@var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
6979depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
6980@command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
6981
cf4a9129
LC
6982When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
6983upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
6984require interaction.
8b315a6d 6985
20dd519c
LC
6986When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
6987randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
6988a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
6989basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
6990
cf4a9129
LC
6991When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
6992network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
6993or addresses.
9bf3c1a7 6994
20dd519c
LC
6995@var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
6996passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
cf4a9129 6997root.
4af2447e 6998
cf4a9129
LC
6999The other options should be self-descriptive.
7000@end deffn
4af2447e 7001
fa0c1d61
LC
7002@defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
7003This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
7004(@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
7005line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
7006on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
7007host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
7008
7009This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
7313a52e
LC
7010@code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
7011@file{/etc/hosts}}):
fa0c1d61
LC
7012
7013@example
7014(use-modules (gnu) (guix))
7015
7016(operating-system
7017 (host-name "mymachine")
7018 ;; ...
7019 (hosts-file
7020 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
7021 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
24e02c28
LC
7022 (plain-file "hosts"
7023 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
7024 %facebook-host-aliases))))
fa0c1d61
LC
7025@end example
7026
7027This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
7028browsers, from accessing Facebook.
7029@end defvr
7030
965a7332
LC
7031The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
7032
be1c2c54 7033@deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
965a7332
LC
7034 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
7035 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
7036 [#:domains-to-browse '()]
7037Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
7038mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
cc9c1f39
LC
7039"zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
7040extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
7041@code{.local} host names using
1065bed9
LC
7042@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
7043add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
7044@command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
965a7332
LC
7045
7046If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
7047publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
7048
7049When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
7050in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
7051address via mDNS on the local network.
7052
7053When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
7054
7055Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
7056sockets.
7057@end deffn
7058
7059
cf4a9129
LC
7060@node X Window
7061@subsubsection X Window
68ad877c 7062
cf4a9129
LC
7063Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
7064Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
7065there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
7066started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
4af2447e 7067
be1c2c54 7068@deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
0ecc3bf3
LC
7069 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
7070 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
4bd43bbe 7071 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
cf4a9129
LC
7072Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
7073turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
7074@code{xorg-start-command}.
4af2447e 7075
04e4e6ab
LC
7076@cindex X session
7077
7078SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
7079files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
7080to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
7081@var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
7082adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
7083available at the log-in screen.
7084
7085In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
7086@file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
7087and/or other X clients.
7088
cf4a9129
LC
7089When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
7090password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
7091@var{default-user}.
0ecc3bf3
LC
7092
7093If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, the use the default log-in theme; otherwise
7094@var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
7095theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
7096theme.
cf4a9129 7097@end deffn
4af2447e 7098
0ecc3bf3
LC
7099@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
7100@defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
7101The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
7102@end defvr
7103
be1c2c54 7104@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
d1cdd7ba 7105 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
f703413e 7106Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
d1cdd7ba
LC
7107from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
7108file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
7109@code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
7110
7111Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
7112@end deffn
7113
be1c2c54 7114@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
12422c9d 7115 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
d1cdd7ba
LC
7116Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
7117all the common drivers.
f703413e
LC
7118
7119@var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
7120graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
d1cdd7ba 7121this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
d2e59637
LC
7122
7123Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
7124appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
7125resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
12422c9d
LC
7126
7127Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
7128@code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
7129verbatim to the configuration file.
f703413e 7130@end deffn
4af2447e 7131
6726282b
LC
7132@deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
7133Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
7134command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
7135for it. For example:
7136
7137@lisp
7138(screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
7139@end lisp
7140
7141makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
7142@end deffn
7143
7144
fe1a39d3
LC
7145@node Desktop Services
7146@subsubsection Desktop Services
aa4ed923 7147
fe1a39d3
LC
7148The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
7149usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
7150machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
7151interfaces, etc.
aa4ed923 7152
4467be21
LC
7153To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
7154services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
7155environment and networking:
7156
7157@defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
7158This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
7159adds or adjust services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
7160
7161In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
6726282b
LC
7162@code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
7163a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
4467be21 7164Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
4650a77e 7165the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
cee32ee4
AW
7166the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
7167Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
7168configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
7169Switch, mDNS}).
4467be21
LC
7170@end defvr
7171
7172The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
7173field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
7174Reference, @code{services}}).
7175
0adfe95a
LC
7176The actual service definitions provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)}
7177and @code{(gnu services desktop)} are described below.
4467be21 7178
0adfe95a 7179@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
fe1a39d3
LC
7180Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
7181support for @var{services}.
aa4ed923 7182
fe1a39d3
LC
7183@uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
7184facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
7185and be notified of system-wide events.
aa4ed923 7186
fe1a39d3
LC
7187@var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
7188@file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
7189and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
7190@var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
aa4ed923
AK
7191@end deffn
7192
0adfe95a 7193@deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
4650a77e
AW
7194Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
7195seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
7196Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
7197are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
7198system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
7199
7200Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
7201example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
7202when the power button is pressed.
7203
7204The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
7205elogind, and should be the result of a @code{(elogind-configuration
7206(@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
7207their default values are:
7208
7209@table @code
7210@item kill-user-processes?
7211@code{#f}
7212@item kill-only-users
7213@code{()}
7214@item kill-exclude-users
7215@code{("root")}
7216@item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
7217@code{5}
7218@item handle-power-key
7219@code{poweroff}
7220@item handle-suspend-key
7221@code{suspend}
7222@item handle-hibernate-key
7223@code{hibernate}
7224@item handle-lid-switch
7225@code{suspend}
7226@item handle-lid-switch-docked
7227@code{ignore}
7228@item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
7229@code{#f}
7230@item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
7231@code{#f}
7232@item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
7233@code{#f}
7234@item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
7235@code{#t}
7236@item holdoff-timeout-seconds
7237@code{30}
7238@item idle-action
7239@code{ignore}
7240@item idle-action-seconds
7241@code{(* 30 60)}
7242@item runtime-directory-size-percent
7243@code{10}
7244@item runtime-directory-size
7245@code{#f}
7246@item remove-ipc?
7247@code{#t}
7248@item suspend-state
7249@code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
7250@item suspend-mode
7251@code{()}
7252@item hibernate-state
7253@code{("disk")}
7254@item hibernate-mode
7255@code{("platform" "shutdown")}
7256@item hybrid-sleep-state
7257@code{("disk")}
7258@item hybrid-sleep-mode
7259@code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
7260@end table
7261@end deffn
7262
be1c2c54 7263@deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
4650a77e 7264 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
222e3319
LC
7265Return a service that runs the
7266@uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
7267management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
7268privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
7269privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
7270capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
7271the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
4650a77e
AW
7272@end deffn
7273
be1c2c54 7274@deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
be234128
AW
7275 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
7276 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
7277 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
7278 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
7279 [#:percentage-low 10] @
7280 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
7281 [#:percentage-action 2] @
7282 [#:time-low 1200] @
7283 [#:time-critical 300] @
7284 [#:time-action 120] @
7285 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
7286Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
7287@command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
7288levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
7289@code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
7290GNOME.
7291@end deffn
7292
2b9e0a94
LC
7293@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
7294Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
7295UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
7296notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
7297include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
7298@end deffn
7299
be1c2c54 7300@deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
7ce597ff
AW
7301Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
7302interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
7303screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
7304tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
7305site} for more information.
7306@end deffn
7307
cee32ee4
AW
7308@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
7309Return an configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
7310location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
7311the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
7312will have access to location information by default. The boolean
7313@var{system?} value indicates that an application is a system component
7314or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
7315this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
7316means that all users are allowed.
7317@end deffn
7318
7319@defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
7320The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
7321granting authority to GNOME's date-and-time utility to ask for the
7322current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the Firefox
7323(IceCat) and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
7324Firefox and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
7325know the user's location.
7326@end defvr
7327
be1c2c54 7328@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
cee32ee4
AW
7329 [#:whitelist '()] @
7330 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
7331 [#:submit-data? #f]
7332 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
7333 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
7334 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
7335Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
7336provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
7337user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
7338location databases. See
7339@uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
7340web site} for more information.
7341@end deffn
7342
105369a4
DT
7343@node Database Services
7344@subsubsection Database Services
7345
7346The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following service.
7347
be1c2c54 7348@deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
105369a4
DT
7349 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data'']
7350Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
7351server.
7352
7353The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from
7354@var{config-file} and stores the database cluster in
7355@var{data-directory}.
7356@end deffn
fe1a39d3 7357
d8c18af8
AW
7358@node Mail Services
7359@subsubsection Mail Services
7360
7361The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
7362for mail services. Currently the only implemented service is Dovecot,
7363an IMAP, POP3, and LMTP server.
7364
7365Guix does not yet have a mail transfer agent (MTA), although for some
7366lightweight purposes the @code{esmtp} relay-only MTA may suffice. Help
7367is needed to properly integrate a full MTA, such as Postfix. Patches
7368welcome!
7369
7370To add an IMAP/POP3 server to a GuixSD system, add a
7371@code{dovecot-service} to the operating system definition:
7372
7373@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
7374Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
7375@end deffn
7376
7377By default, Dovecot doesn't need much configuration; the default
7378configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
7379suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
7380certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
7381Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
7382number of options though which mail administrators might need to change,
7383and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
7384administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
7385
7386For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
7387one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
7388
7389@example
7390(dovecot-service #:config
7391 (dovecot-configuration
7392 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
7393@end example
7394
7395The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
7396definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
7397indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
7398strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
7399if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
7400from some other system; see the end for more details.
7401
7402@c The following documentation was initially generated by
7403@c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
7404@c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
7405@c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
7406@c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
7407@c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
7408@c the churn as dovecot updates.
7409
7410Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
7411
7412@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
7413The dovecot package.
7414@end deftypevr
7415
7416@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
7417A list of IPs or hosts where to listen in for connections. @samp{*}
7418listens in all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens in all IPv6
7419interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
7420complex, customize the address and port fields of the
7421@samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
7422@end deftypevr
7423
7424@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
7425List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
7426@samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
7427
7428Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
7429
7430@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
7431The name of the protocol.
7432@end deftypevr
7433
7434@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
7435UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
7436This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
7437Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
7438@end deftypevr
7439
7440@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
7441Space separated list of plugins to load.
7442@end deftypevr
7443
7444@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
7445Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
7446address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
7447Defaults to @samp{10}.
7448@end deftypevr
7449
7450@end deftypevr
7451
7452@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
7453List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
7454@samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
7455@samp{lmtp}.
7456
7457Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
7458
7459@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
7460The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
7461@code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
7462@code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
7463@code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
7464@end deftypevr
7465
7466@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
7467Listeners for the service. A listener is either an
7468@code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
7469an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
7470Defaults to @samp{()}.
7471
7472Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
7473
7474@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7475The file name on which to listen.
7476@end deftypevr
7477
7478@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7479The access mode for the socket.
7480Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7481@end deftypevr
7482
7483@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7484The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7485Defaults to @samp{""}.
7486@end deftypevr
7487
7488@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7489The group to own the socket.
7490Defaults to @samp{""}.
7491@end deftypevr
7492
7493
7494Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
7495
7496@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7497The file name on which to listen.
7498@end deftypevr
7499
7500@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7501The access mode for the socket.
7502Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7503@end deftypevr
7504
7505@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7506The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7507Defaults to @samp{""}.
7508@end deftypevr
7509
7510@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7511The group to own the socket.
7512Defaults to @samp{""}.
7513@end deftypevr
7514
7515
7516Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
7517
7518@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
7519The protocol to listen for.
7520@end deftypevr
7521
7522@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
7523The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
7524Defaults to @samp{""}.
7525@end deftypevr
7526
7527@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
7528The port on which to listen.
7529@end deftypevr
7530
7531@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
7532Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
7533@samp{required}.
7534Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7535@end deftypevr
7536
7537@end deftypevr
7538
7539@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
7540Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
7541Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
7542secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
7543Defaults to @samp{1}.
7544@end deftypevr
7545
7546@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
7547Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
7548Defaults to @samp{0}.
7549@end deftypevr
7550
7551@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
7552If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
7553this.
7554Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
7555@end deftypevr
7556
7557@end deftypevr
7558
7559@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
7560Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
7561constructor.
7562
7563Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
7564
7565@deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
7566A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
7567Defaults to @samp{()}.
7568@end deftypevr
7569
7570@end deftypevr
7571
7572@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
7573List of passdb configurations, each one created by the
7574@code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
7575
7576Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
7577
7578@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7579The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
7580@samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
7581@samp{static}.
7582Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
7583@end deftypevr
7584
7585@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7586A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
7587Defaults to @samp{()}.
7588@end deftypevr
7589
7590@end deftypevr
7591
7592@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
7593List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
7594@code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
7595
7596Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
7597
7598@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7599The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
7600@samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
7601Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
7602@end deftypevr
7603
7604@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7605A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
7606Defaults to @samp{()}.
7607@end deftypevr
7608
7609@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
7610Override fields from passwd.
7611Defaults to @samp{()}.
7612@end deftypevr
7613
7614@end deftypevr
7615
7616@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
7617Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
7618constructor.
7619@end deftypevr
7620
7621@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
7622List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
7623@code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
7624
7625Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
7626
7627@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
7628Name for this namespace.
7629@end deftypevr
7630
7631@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
7632Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
7633Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
7634@end deftypevr
7635
7636@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
7637Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
7638all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
7639one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
7640format.
7641Defaults to @samp{""}.
7642@end deftypevr
7643
7644@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
7645Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
7646different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
7647Defaults to @samp{""}.
7648@end deftypevr
7649
7650@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
7651Physical location of the mailbox. This is in same format as
7652mail_location, which is also the default for it.
7653Defaults to @samp{""}.
7654@end deftypevr
7655
7656@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
7657There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
7658namespace has it.
7659Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7660@end deftypevr
7661
7662@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
7663If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
7664extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
7665useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
7666which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
7667create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
7668and @samp{mail/}.
7669Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7670@end deftypevr
7671
7672@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
7673Show the mailboxes under this namespace with LIST command. This
7674makes the namespace visible for clients that don't support NAMESPACE
7675extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
7676hides the namespace prefix.
7677Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7678@end deftypevr
7679
7680@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
7681Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
7682parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
7683as @code{#t}.)
7684Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7685@end deftypevr
7686
7687@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
7688List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
7689Defaults to @samp{()}.
7690
7691Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
7692
7693@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
7694Name for this mailbox.
7695@end deftypevr
7696
7697@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
7698@samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
7699@samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
7700Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
7701@end deftypevr
7702
7703@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
7704List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
7705Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
7706@code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
7707Defaults to @samp{()}.
7708@end deftypevr
7709
7710@end deftypevr
7711
7712@end deftypevr
7713
7714@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
7715Base directory where to store runtime data.
7716Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
7717@end deftypevr
7718
7719@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
7720Greeting message for clients.
7721Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
7722@end deftypevr
7723
7724@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
7725List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
7726allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
7727authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
7728for these networks. Typically you'd specify your IMAP proxy servers
7729here.
7730Defaults to @samp{()}.
7731@end deftypevr
7732
7733@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
7734List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
7735Defaults to @samp{()}.
7736@end deftypevr
7737
7738@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
7739Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
7740and IP address. Useful for seeing who are actually using the IMAP
7741processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if same uid is used for multiple
7742accounts).
7743Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7744@end deftypevr
7745
7746@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
7747Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
7748Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
7749forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
7750be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. because of a security fix).
7751Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7752@end deftypevr
7753
7754@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
7755If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
7756server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
7757Defaults to @samp{0}.
7758@end deftypevr
7759
7760@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
7761UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
7762Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
7763@end deftypevr
7764
7765@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
7766List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
7767and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
7768key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
7769@end deftypevr
7770
7771@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
7772Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
7773SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
7774matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
7775the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
7776allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
7777Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7778@end deftypevr
7779
7780@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
7781Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
7782Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
7783for caching to be used.
7784Defaults to @samp{0}.
7785@end deftypevr
7786
7787@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
7788Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
7789is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
7790failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
7791user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
7792cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
7793authentication.
7794Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7795@end deftypevr
7796
7797@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
7798TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
77990 disables caching them completely.
7800Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7801@end deftypevr
7802
7803@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
7804List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
7805You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
7806Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
7807realm first.
7808Defaults to @samp{()}.
7809@end deftypevr
7810
7811@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
7812Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
7813both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
7814logins.
7815Defaults to @samp{""}.
7816@end deftypevr
7817
7818@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
7819List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
7820contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
7821This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
7822potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
7823you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
7824Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
7825@end deftypevr
7826
7827@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
7828Username character translations before it's looked up from
7829databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
7830example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
7831translated to @samp{@@}.
7832Defaults to @samp{""}.
7833@end deftypevr
7834
7835@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
7836Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
7837use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
7838%n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
7839change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
7840@samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
7841Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
7842@end deftypevr
7843
7844@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
7845If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
7846username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
7847mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
7848here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
7849UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
7850choice.
7851Defaults to @samp{""}.
7852@end deftypevr
7853
7854@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
7855Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
7856mechanism.
7857Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
7858@end deftypevr
7859
7860@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
7861Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
7862execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
7863They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
7864Defaults to @samp{30}.
7865@end deftypevr
7866
7867@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
7868Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
7869the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
7870allow all keytab entries.
7871Defaults to @samp{""}.
7872@end deftypevr
7873
7874@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
7875Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
7876system default (usually /etc/krb5.keytab) if not specified. You may
7877need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
7878file.
7879Defaults to @samp{""}.
7880@end deftypevr
7881
7882@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
7883Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
7884and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
7885<doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
7886Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7887@end deftypevr
7888
7889@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
7890Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
7891Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
7892@end deftypevr
7893
7894@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
7895Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
7896Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
7897@end deftypevr
7898
7899@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
7900Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
7901fails.
7902Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7903@end deftypevr
7904
7905@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
7906Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
7907@code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
7908CommonName.
7909Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7910@end deftypevr
7911
7912@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
7913List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
7914@samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
7915@samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
7916@samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
7917@samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
7918@end deftypevr
7919
7920@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
7921List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
7922Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
7923director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
7924Defaults to @samp{()}.
7925@end deftypevr
7926
7927@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
7928List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
7929allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
7930Defaults to @samp{()}.
7931@end deftypevr
7932
7933@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
7934How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
7935has any connections.
7936Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
7937@end deftypevr
7938
7939@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
7940TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
7941connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
7942@samp{inet-listener} for the port.
7943Defaults to @samp{0}.
7944@end deftypevr
7945
7946@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
7947How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
7948include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
7949are shared within domain.
7950Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
7951@end deftypevr
7952
7953@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
7954Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
7955@samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
7956Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
7957@end deftypevr
7958
7959@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
7960Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
7961@samp{log-path}.
7962Defaults to @samp{""}.
7963@end deftypevr
7964
7965@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
7966Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
7967@samp{info-log-path}.
7968Defaults to @samp{""}.
7969@end deftypevr
7970
7971@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
7972Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
7973don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
7974standard facilities are supported.
7975Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
7976@end deftypevr
7977
7978@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
7979Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
7980failed.
7981Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7982@end deftypevr
7983
7984@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
7985In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
7986values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
7987force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
7988and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
7989":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
7990Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7991@end deftypevr
7992
7993@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
7994Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
7995SQL queries.
7996Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7997@end deftypevr
7998
7999@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
8000In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
8001the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
8002@samp{auth-debug}.
8003Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8004@end deftypevr
8005
8006@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
8007Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
8008Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
8009Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8010@end deftypevr
8011
8012@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
8013Show protocol level SSL errors.
8014Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8015@end deftypevr
8016
8017@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
8018Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
8019strftime(3) format.
8020Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
8021@end deftypevr
8022
8023@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
8024List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
8025non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
8026string.
8027@end deftypevr
8028
8029@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
8030Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
8031string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
8032Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
8033@end deftypevr
8034
8035@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
8036Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
8037of possible variables you can use.
8038Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
8039@end deftypevr
8040
8041@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
8042Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
8043@table @code
8044@item %$
8045Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
8046@item %m
8047Message-ID
8048@item %s
8049Subject
8050@item %f
8051From address
8052@item %p
8053Physical size
8054@item %w
8055Virtual size.
8056@end table
8057Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
8058@end deftypevr
8059
8060@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
8061Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
8062that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
8063if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
8064Dovecot the full location.
8065
8066If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
8067file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
8068where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
8069directory", and it must be the first path given in the
8070@samp{mail-location} setting.
8071
8072There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
8073
8074@table @samp
8075@item %u
8076username
8077@item %n
8078user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
8079@item %d
8080domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
8081@item %h
8082home director
8083@end table
8084
8085See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
8086@table @samp
8087@item maildir:~/Maildir
8088@item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
8089@item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
8090@end table
8091Defaults to @samp{""}.
8092@end deftypevr
8093
8094@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
8095System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
8096userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
8097either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
8098Defaults to @samp{""}.
8099@end deftypevr
8100
8101@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
8102
8103Defaults to @samp{""}.
8104@end deftypevr
8105
8106@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
8107Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
8108this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
8109dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
8110/var/mail.
8111Defaults to @samp{""}.
8112@end deftypevr
8113
8114@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
8115Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
8116Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
8117that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
8118symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
8119could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
8120/secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
8121Defaults to @samp{""}.
8122@end deftypevr
8123
8124@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
8125Allow full filesystem access to clients. There's no access checks
8126other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
8127works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
8128names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
8129Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8130@end deftypevr
8131
8132@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
8133Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
8134shared filesystems (NFS or clustered filesystem).
8135Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8136@end deftypevr
8137
8138@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
8139Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
8140supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
8141nowadays by default.
8142Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8143@end deftypevr
8144
8145@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
8146When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
8147@table @code
8148@item optimized
8149Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
8150@item always
8151Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
8152@item never
8153Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
8154@end table
8155Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
8156@end deftypevr
8157
8158@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
8159Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
8160NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
8161this isn't needed.
8162Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8163@end deftypevr
8164
8165@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
8166Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
8167@samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
8168Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8169@end deftypevr
8170
8171@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
8172Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
8173dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
8174than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
8175change @samp{mmap-disable}.
8176Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
8177@end deftypevr
8178
8179@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
8180Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
8181kB.
8182Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
8183@end deftypevr
8184
8185@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
8186Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
8187log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
8188hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
8189is set to 0.
8190Defaults to @samp{500}.
8191@end deftypevr
8192
8193@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
8194
8195Defaults to @samp{0}.
8196@end deftypevr
8197
8198@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
8199Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
8200aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
8201non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
8202Defaults to @samp{1}.
8203@end deftypevr
8204
8205@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
8206
8207Defaults to @samp{0}.
8208@end deftypevr
8209
8210@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
8211Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
8212trying to create new keywords.
8213Defaults to @samp{50}.
8214@end deftypevr
8215
8216@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
8217List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
8218processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
8219too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
8220@samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
8221"/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
8222which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
8223this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
8224<doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8225Defaults to @samp{()}.
8226@end deftypevr
8227
8228@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
8229Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
8230for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
8231directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
8232there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
8233access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
8234directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
8235@samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8236Defaults to @samp{""}.
8237@end deftypevr
8238
8239@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
8240UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
8241This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
8242Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
8243@end deftypevr
8244
8245@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
8246Directory where to look up mail plugins.
8247Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
8248@end deftypevr
8249
8250@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
8251List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
8252LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
8253Defaults to @samp{()}.
8254@end deftypevr
8255
8256@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
8257The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
8258cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
8259writes at the cost of more disk reads.
8260Defaults to @samp{0}.
8261@end deftypevr
8262
8263@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
8264When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
8265see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
8266the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
8267dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
8268occur.
8269Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
8270@end deftypevr
8271
8272@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
8273Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
8274mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
8275FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
8276slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
8277they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
8278Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8279@end deftypevr
8280
8281@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
8282By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
8283with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
8284which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
8285causes more disk I/O.
8286 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
8287and it's done always regardless of this setting).
8288Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8289@end deftypevr
8290
8291@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
8292When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
8293This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
8294side effects.
8295Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8296@end deftypevr
8297
8298@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
8299Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
8300directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
8301the mail otherwise.
8302Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8303@end deftypevr
8304
8305@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
8306Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
8307available:
8308
8309@table @code
8310@item dotlock
8311Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
8312solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
8313need write access to that directory.
8314@item dotlock-try
8315Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
8316isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
8317@item fcntl
8318Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
8319@item flock
8320May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8321@item lockf
8322May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8323@end table
8324
8325You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
8326in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
8327locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
8328them simultaneously.
8329@end deftypevr
8330
8331@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
8332
8333@end deftypevr
8334
8335@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
8336Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
8337Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
8338@end deftypevr
8339
8340@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
8341If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
8342override the lock file after this much time.
8343Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8344@end deftypevr
8345
8346@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
8347When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
8348what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
8349the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
8350simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
8351this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
8352whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
8353downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
8354flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
8355done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
8356Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8357@end deftypevr
8358
8359@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
8360Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
8361EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
8362@samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
8363Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8364@end deftypevr
8365
8366@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
8367Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
8368and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
8369useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
8370that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
8371Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8372@end deftypevr
8373
8374@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
8375If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
8376files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
8377updated.
8378Defaults to @samp{0}.
8379@end deftypevr
8380
8381@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
8382Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
8383Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
8384@end deftypevr
8385
8386@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
8387Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
8388begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
8389disabled.
8390Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
8391@end deftypevr
8392
8393@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
8394When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
8395@samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
8396with some filesystems (ext4, xfs).
8397Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8398@end deftypevr
8399
8400@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
8401sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
8402which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
8403don't support this for now.
8404
8405WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
8406
8407Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
8408Defaults to @samp{""}.
8409@end deftypevr
8410
8411@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
8412Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
8413possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
8414externally.
8415Defaults to @samp{128000}.
8416@end deftypevr
8417
8418@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
8419Filesystem backend to use for saving attachments:
8420@table @code
8421@item posix
8422No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
8423@item sis posix
8424SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
8425@item sis-queue posix
8426SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
8427@end table
8428Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
8429@end deftypevr
8430
8431@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
8432Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
8433variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
8434@code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
8435truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
8436Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
8437@end deftypevr
8438
8439@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
8440
8441Defaults to @samp{100}.
8442@end deftypevr
8443
8444@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
8445
8446Defaults to @samp{1000}.
8447@end deftypevr
8448
8449@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
8450Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
8451This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
8452before they eat up everything.
8453Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
8454@end deftypevr
8455
8456@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
8457Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
8458untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
8459at all.
8460Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
8461@end deftypevr
8462
8463@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
8464Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
8465separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
8466processes.
8467Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
8468@end deftypevr
8469
8470@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
8471SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
8472Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
8473@end deftypevr
8474
8475@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
8476PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
8477Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
8478@end deftypevr
8479
8480@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
8481PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
8482dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
8483root.
8484Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
8485@end deftypevr
8486
8487@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
8488If key file is password protected, give the password here.
8489Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
8490this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
8491instead to a different.
8492Defaults to @samp{""}.
8493@end deftypevr
8494
8495@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
8496PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
8497intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
8498contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
8499CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
8500Defaults to @samp{""}.
8501@end deftypevr
8502
8503@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
8504Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
8505Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8506@end deftypevr
8507
8508@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
8509Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
8510it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
8511Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8512@end deftypevr
8513
8514@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
8515Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
8516x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
8517@samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
8518Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
8519@end deftypevr
8520
8521@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
8522How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
8523quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
8524regeneration entirely.
8525Defaults to @samp{168}.
8526@end deftypevr
8527
8528@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
8529SSL protocols to use.
8530Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
8531@end deftypevr
8532
8533@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
8534SSL ciphers to use.
8535Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
8536@end deftypevr
8537
8538@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
8539SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
8540Defaults to @samp{""}.
8541@end deftypevr
8542
8543@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
8544Address to use when sending rejection mails.
8545Default is postmaster@@<your domain>. %d expands to recipient domain.
8546Defaults to @samp{""}.
8547@end deftypevr
8548
8549@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
8550Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
8551and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
8552Defaults to @samp{""}.
8553@end deftypevr
8554
8555@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
8556If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
8557bouncing the mail.
8558Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8559@end deftypevr
8560
8561@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
8562Binary to use for sending mails.
8563Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
8564@end deftypevr
8565
8566@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
8567If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
8568sendmail.
8569Defaults to @samp{""}.
8570@end deftypevr
8571
8572@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
8573Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
8574variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
8575Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
8576@end deftypevr
8577
8578@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
8579Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
8580variables:
8581
8582@table @code
8583@item %n
8584CRLF
8585@item %r
8586reason
8587@item %s
8588original subject
8589@item %t
8590recipient
8591@end table
8592Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
8593@end deftypevr
8594
8595@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
8596Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
8597address.
8598Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
8599@end deftypevr
8600
8601@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
8602Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
8603address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
8604parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
8605X-Original-To.
8606Defaults to @samp{""}.
8607@end deftypevr
8608
8609@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
8610Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
8611it?.
8612Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8613@end deftypevr
8614
8615@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
8616Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
8617subscribed?.
8618Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8619@end deftypevr
8620
8621@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
8622Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
8623command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
8624get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
8625often.
8626Defaults to @samp{64000}.
8627@end deftypevr
8628
8629@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
8630IMAP logout format string:
8631@table @code
8632@item %i
8633total number of bytes read from client
8634@item %o
8635total number of bytes sent to client.
8636@end table
8637Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
8638@end deftypevr
8639
8640@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
8641Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
8642add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
8643Defaults to @samp{""}.
8644@end deftypevr
8645
8646@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
8647How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
8648is IDLEing.
8649Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8650@end deftypevr
8651
8652@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
8653ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
8654makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
8655values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
8656support-email.
8657Defaults to @samp{""}.
8658@end deftypevr
8659
8660@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
8661ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
8662Defaults to @samp{""}.
8663@end deftypevr
8664
8665@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
8666Workarounds for various client bugs:
8667
8668@table @code
8669@item delay-newmail
8670Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
8671CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
8672Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
8673may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
8674still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
8675"Headers Only".
8676
8677@item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
8678Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
8679adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
8680ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
8681
8682@item tb-lsub-flags
8683Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
8684This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
8685greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
8686@end table
8687Defaults to @samp{()}.
8688@end deftypevr
8689
8690@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
8691Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
8692Defaults to @samp{""}.
8693@end deftypevr
8694
8695
8696Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
8697that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
8698language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
8699but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
8700inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
8701
8702However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
8703and running. In that case, you can pass an
8704@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} paramter to
8705@code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
8706does not have easy reflective capabilities.
8707
8708Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
8709
8710@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
8711The dovecot package.
8712@end deftypevr
8713
8714@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
8715The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
8716@end deftypevr
8717
8718For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
8719could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
8720
8721@example
8722(dovecot-service #:config
8723 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
8724 (string "")))
8725@end example
8726
58724c48
DT
8727@node Web Services
8728@subsubsection Web Services
8729
8730The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
8731
be1c2c54 8732@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
58724c48
DT
8733 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
8734 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
8735 [#:config-file]
8736
8737Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
8738
8739The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
8740Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
8741files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
8742arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
8743directories are created when the service is activated.
8744
8745@end deffn
8746
fe1a39d3
LC
8747@node Various Services
8748@subsubsection Various Services
8749
8750The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
8751
be1c2c54 8752@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
fe1a39d3
LC
8753 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
8754 [#:extra-options '()]
8755Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
8756decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
8757
8758Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
8759(configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
8760for details.
8761
8762Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
8763passed to @command{lircd}.
8764@end deffn
8765
8766
0ae8c15a
LC
8767@node Setuid Programs
8768@subsection Setuid Programs
8769
8770@cindex setuid programs
8771Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
8772launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
4d40227c
LC
8773@command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
8774password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
0ae8c15a
LC
8775@file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
8776obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
8777@dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
8778(@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
f7e4ae7f 8779for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
0ae8c15a
LC
8780
8781The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
8782security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
8783populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
8784used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
8785the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
8786should be setuid root.
8787
8788The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
8789declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
8790programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
8791For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
8792package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
8793
8794@example
8795#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
8796@end example
8797
8798A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
8799@code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
8800
8801@defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
8802A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
8803
8804The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
8805@command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
8806@end defvr
8807
8808Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
8809@file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
8810files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
8811store.
8812
efb5e833
LC
8813@node X.509 Certificates
8814@subsection X.509 Certificates
8815
8816@cindex HTTPS, certificates
8817@cindex X.509 certificates
8818@cindex TLS
8819Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
8820security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
8821that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
8822that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
8823so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
8824signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
8825
8826Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
8827certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
8828out-of-the-box.
8829
8830However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
8831@command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
8832certificates can be found.
8833
8834@cindex @code{nss-certs}
8835In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
8836to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
8837(@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
8838@code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
8839Mozilla's Network Security Services.
8840
8841Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
8842explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
8843most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
8844to the certificates installed globally.
8845
8846Unprivileged users can also install their own certificate package in
8847their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
8848that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
8849OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
8850variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
8851instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
8852pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable.
8853
8854
996ed739
LC
8855@node Name Service Switch
8856@subsection Name Service Switch
8857
8858@cindex name service switch
8859@cindex NSS
8860The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
8861configuration file of libc's @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
8862(@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
8863Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
8864extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
8865includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
8866Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
8867C Library Reference Manual}).
8868
8869The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
8870method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
8871together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
8872next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
8873@code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
8874(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
8875
4c9050c6
LC
8876@cindex nss-mdns
8877@cindex .local, host name lookup
996ed739 8878As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
4c9050c6
LC
8879@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
8880back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
8881for host names ending in @code{.local}:
996ed739
LC
8882
8883@example
8884(name-service-switch
8885 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
8886
8887 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
8888 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
8889 (name-service
8890 (name "mdns_minimal")
8891
8892 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
8893 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
8894 ;; no need to try the next methods.
8895 (reaction (lookup-specification
8896 (not-found => return))))
8897
8898 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
8899 (name-service
8900 (name "dns"))
8901
8902 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
8903 (name-service
8904 (name "mdns")))))
8905@end example
8906
15137a29
LC
8907Don't worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
8908contains this configuration, so you won't have to type it if all you
8909want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
8910
4c9050c6
LC
8911Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
8912@code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
cc9c1f39
LC
8913you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
8914@code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
8915(@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
8916to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
8917@code{nscd-service}}).
15137a29
LC
8918
8919For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
8920configurations.
8921
8922@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
8923This is the default name service switch configuration, a
8924@code{name-service-switch} object.
8925@end defvr
8926
8927@defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
8928This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
8929lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
8930@end defvr
4c9050c6 8931
996ed739
LC
8932The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
8933is a direct mapping of the C library's configuration file format, so
8934please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
8935Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8936Compared to libc's NSS configuration file format, it has the advantage
8937not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
8938static checks: you'll know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
8939run @command{guix system}.
8940
996ed739
LC
8941@deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
8942
8943This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
8944service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
8945system databases.
8946
8947@table @code
8948@item aliases
8949@itemx ethers
8950@itemx group
8951@itemx gshadow
8952@itemx hosts
8953@itemx initgroups
8954@itemx netgroup
8955@itemx networks
8956@itemx password
8957@itemx public-key
8958@itemx rpc
8959@itemx services
8960@itemx shadow
8961The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
8962list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below.)
8963@end table
8964@end deftp
8965
8966@deftp {Data Type} name-service
8967
8968This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
8969associated lookup action.
8970
8971@table @code
8972@item name
8973A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
8974configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8975
4aee6e60
LC
8976Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
8977achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
8978@code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
8979services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
8980
996ed739
LC
8981@item reaction
8982An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
8983(@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
8984Reference Manual}). For example:
8985
8986@example
8987(lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
8988 (success => return))
8989@end example
8990@end table
8991@end deftp
0ae8c15a 8992
fd1b1fa2
LC
8993@node Initial RAM Disk
8994@subsection Initial RAM Disk
8995
8996@cindex initial RAM disk (initrd)
8997@cindex initrd (initial RAM disk)
8998For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
8999@dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
9000root file system, as well as an initialization script. The latter is
9001responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
9002kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
9003
9004The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
9005you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
9006system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
9007high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
9008@code{expression->initrd} procedure.
9009
9010The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
9011For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
9012at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
9013system declaration like this:
9014
9015@example
52ac153e 9016(initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
027981d6
LC
9017 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
9018 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
9019 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
52ac153e 9020 (apply base-initrd file-systems
027981d6 9021 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
52ac153e 9022 rest)))
fd1b1fa2
LC
9023@end example
9024
52ac153e
LC
9025The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
9026involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system whose
9027root file system is volatile.
fd1b1fa2 9028
e90cf6c1
LC
9029The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
9030options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
9031passed @i{via} GRUB's @code{linux} command, or with QEMU's
9032@code{-append} option), notably:
9033
9034@table @code
9035@item --load=@var{boot}
9036Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
9037program, once it has mounted the root file system.
9038
9039GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
dd17bc38 9040service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
e90cf6c1
LC
9041initialization system.
9042
9043@item --root=@var{root}
9044Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
9045device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
9046UUID.
9047
9048@item --system=@var{system}
9049Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
9050@var{system}.
9051
9052@item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
9053@cindex module, black-listing
9054@cindex black list, of kernel modules
9055Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
9056(from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
9057must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
9058@code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
9059
9060@item --repl
9061Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
9062tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
9063marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
9064love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
9065Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
9066
9067@end table
9068
9069Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
9070@code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
9071further.
9072
fd1b1fa2 9073@deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
9059b97d 9074 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
52ac153e 9075 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9076Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
9077a list of file-systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
9078the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
52ac153e
LC
9079@var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
9080@var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
fd1b1fa2
LC
9081
9082When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
9083parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so the initrd can
9084be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
9085
9086When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
9087to it are lost.
9088
9089The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
9090for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
9091modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
9092loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
9093@end deffn
9094
9095Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
9096statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
9097program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
9098@code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
9099program to run in that initrd.
9100
9101@deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
9102 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"] @
42d10464 9103 [#:modules '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9104Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
9105containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
df650fa8
LC
9106upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
9107automatically copied to the initrd.
fd1b1fa2 9108
42d10464
LC
9109@var{modules} is a list of Guile module names to be embedded in the
9110initrd.
fd1b1fa2
LC
9111@end deffn
9112
88faf933
LC
9113@node GRUB Configuration
9114@subsection GRUB Configuration
9115
9116@cindex GRUB
9117@cindex boot loader
9118
9119The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
9120(@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
9121configured using @code{grub-configuration} declarations. This data type
9122is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module, and described below.
9123
9124@deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
9125The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
9126
9127@table @asis
9128
9129@item @code{device}
9130This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
9131understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
9132@code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
9133GNU GRUB Manual}).
9134
9135@item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
9136A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
9137entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
9138system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
9139
9140@item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
9141The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the current
9142system's entry.
9143
9144@item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
9145The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
91460 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
9147
9148@item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
9149The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
9150@end table
9151
9152@end deftp
9153
9154Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
9155@code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
9156@code{menu-entry} form:
9157
9158@deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
9159The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
9160
9161@table @asis
9162
9163@item @code{label}
35ed9306 9164The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
88faf933
LC
9165
9166@item @code{linux}
9167The Linux kernel to boot.
9168
9169@item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
9170The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
9171@code{("console=ttyS0")}.
9172
9173@item @code{initrd}
9174A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
9175to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
9176
9177@end table
9178@end deftp
9179
9180@c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
9181Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
9182documented yet.
9183
9184@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
9185This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
9186fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
9187@end defvr
9188
9189
cf4a9129
LC
9190@node Invoking guix system
9191@subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
0918e64a 9192
cf4a9129
LC
9193Once you have written an operating system declaration, as seen in the
9194previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
9195system} command. The synopsis is:
4af2447e 9196
cf4a9129
LC
9197@example
9198guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
9199@end example
4af2447e 9200
cf4a9129
LC
9201@var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
9202@code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
9203operating system is instantiate. Currently the following values are
9204supported:
4af2447e 9205
cf4a9129
LC
9206@table @code
9207@item reconfigure
9208Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
9209switch to it@footnote{This action is usable only on systems already
65797bff 9210running GuixSD.}.
4af2447e 9211
cf4a9129
LC
9212This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
9213accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
240b57f0
LC
9214The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
9215currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
9216attempt to upgrade it since it would not be possible without stopping it
9217first.
4af2447e 9218
cf4a9129
LC
9219It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
9220entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
9221@option{--no-grub} is passed.
4af2447e 9222
240b57f0 9223@quotation Note
bf2479c7
LC
9224@c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
9225@c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
9226It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
9227@command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
9228guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
9229once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
240b57f0 9230@end quotation
bf2479c7 9231
cf4a9129
LC
9232@item build
9233Build the operating system's derivation, which includes all the
9234configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
9235This action does not actually install anything.
113daf62 9236
cf4a9129
LC
9237@item init
9238Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
9239operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
4705641f 9240installations of GuixSD. For instance:
113daf62
LC
9241
9242@example
cf4a9129 9243guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
113daf62
LC
9244@end example
9245
cf4a9129
LC
9246copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
9247specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
9248files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
9249needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
9250@file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
113daf62 9251
cf4a9129
LC
9252This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
9253@file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
113daf62 9254
cf4a9129
LC
9255@item vm
9256@cindex virtual machine
0276f697 9257@cindex VM
f535dcbe 9258@anchor{guix system vm}
cf4a9129
LC
9259Build a virtual machine that contain the operating system declared in
9260@var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
810568b3 9261Arguments given to the script are passed as is to QEMU.
113daf62 9262
cf4a9129 9263The VM shares its store with the host system.
113daf62 9264
0276f697
LC
9265Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
9266the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
9267specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
9268provides read-only access to the shared directory.
9269
9270The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
9271accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
9272read-write mapping of the host's @file{$HOME/tmp}:
9273
9274@example
9275guix system vm my-config.scm \
9276 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9277@end example
9278
6aa260af
LC
9279On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
9280the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
9281host's store can then be mounted.
9282
9283The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
9284with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
9285containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
9286be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
9287image's size.
ab11f0be 9288
cf4a9129
LC
9289@item vm-image
9290@itemx disk-image
9291Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
9292in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
9293to specify the size of the image.
113daf62 9294
cf4a9129 9295When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
97d76250
LF
9296the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
9297for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
113daf62 9298
cf4a9129
LC
9299When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
9300copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
9301the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image on it
9302using the following command:
113daf62 9303
cf4a9129
LC
9304@example
9305# dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
9306@end example
113daf62 9307
1c8a81b1
DT
9308@item container
9309Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
9310within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
9311mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
9312substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
9313the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
9314host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
9315
9316Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
9317a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
9318system.
9319
9320As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
9321systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
9322using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
9323
9324@example
9325guix system container my-config.scm \
9326 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9327@end example
9328
0f252e26 9329@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 9330This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
9331@end quotation
9332
cf4a9129 9333@end table
113daf62 9334
ccd7158d
LC
9335@var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
9336Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
9337following:
113daf62 9338
cf4a9129
LC
9339@table @option
9340@item --system=@var{system}
9341@itemx -s @var{system}
9342Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host's system type.
9343This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
113daf62 9344
f3f427c2
LC
9345@item --derivation
9346@itemx -d
9347Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
9348building anything.
9349
cf4a9129
LC
9350@item --image-size=@var{size}
9351For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
9352of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
4a44d7bb
LC
9353include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
9354coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
db030303
LC
9355
9356@item --on-error=@var{strategy}
9357Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
9358@var{strategy} may be one of the following:
9359
9360@table @code
9361@item nothing-special
9362Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
9363
9364@item backtrace
9365Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
9366
9367@item debug
9368Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
9369commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
9370display local variable values, and more generally inspect the program's
9371state. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
9372a list of available debugging commands.
9373@end table
113daf62 9374@end table
113daf62 9375
cf4a9129
LC
9376Note that all the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
9377rely on KVM support in the Linux-Libre kernel. Specifically, the
9378machine should have hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
9379KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
9380must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the daemon's
9381build users.
8451a568 9382
65797bff
LC
9383Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
9384your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
9385system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
9386GRUB boot menu:
9387
9388@table @code
9389
9390@item list-generations
9391List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
9392disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
9393@option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
9394(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
9395
9396Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
9397in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
9398generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
9399generations up to 10-day old:
9400
9401@example
9402$ guix system list-generations 10d
9403@end example
9404
9405@end table
9406
d6c3267a
LC
9407The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
9408sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
9409each other:
9410
9411@anchor{system-extension-graph}
9412@table @code
9413
9414@item extension-graph
9415Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
9416extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
9417(@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
9418extensions.)
9419
9420The command:
9421
9422@example
9423$ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
9424@end example
9425
9426produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
9427
710fa231
AK
9428@anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
9429@item shepherd-graph
6f305ea5 9430Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
dd17bc38
AK
9431graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
9432@var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
9433example graph.
6f305ea5 9434
d6c3267a
LC
9435@end table
9436
97d76250
LF
9437@node Running GuixSD in a VM
9438@subsection Running GuixSD in a virtual machine
9439
9440One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
9441virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
9442(@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
9443which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
9444
9445To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
9446and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
9447you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
9448platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
9449of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
9450
9451@example
9452$ qemu-system-x86_64 \
9453 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
9454 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
9455@end example
9456
9457Here is what each of these options means:
9458
9459@table @code
9460@item qemu-system-x86_64
9461This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
9462host.
9463
9464@item -net user
9465Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
9466access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
9467guest OS online. If you don't choose a network stack, the boot will
9468fail.
9469
9470@item -net nic,model=virtio
9471You must create a network interface of a given model. If you don't
9472create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
9473x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
9474@command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
9475
9476@item -enable-kvm
9477If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
9478Linux kernel's virtual machine support (KVM) will make things run
9479faster.
9480
9481@item -m 256
9482RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
9483which may be insufficent for some operations.
9484
9485@item /tmp/qemu-image
9486The file name of the qcow2 image.
9487@end table
d6c3267a 9488
cf4a9129
LC
9489@node Defining Services
9490@subsection Defining Services
8451a568 9491
eb524192 9492The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
0adfe95a
LC
9493them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
9494them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
8451a568 9495
0adfe95a
LC
9496@menu
9497* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
9498* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
9499* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 9500* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a
LC
9501@end menu
9502
9503@node Service Composition
9504@subsubsection Service Composition
9505
9506@cindex services
9507@cindex daemons
9508Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
9509operating system's functionality. Often a service is a process---a
9510@dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
9511Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
9512whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
9513started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
9514@command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
9515daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
9516and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
9517collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
9518daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the system's @file{/etc}
9519directory.
9520
d6c3267a 9521@cindex service extensions
0adfe95a 9522GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
dd17bc38
AK
9523secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---GuixSD's
9524initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
9525lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
9526Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
9527service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
9528udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
9529Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
9530Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
9531and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
9532user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9533
9534All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
9535acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
9536as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
9537
9538@image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
9539
d62e201c
LC
9540@cindex system service
9541At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
9542directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
9543by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
9544to learn about the other service types shown here.
d6c3267a
LC
9545@xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
9546command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
9547particular operating system definition.
0adfe95a
LC
9548
9549@cindex service types
9550Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
9551relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
9552system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
9553shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
9554different parameters.
9555
9556The following section describes the programming interface for service
9557types and services.
9558
9559@node Service Types and Services
9560@subsubsection Service Types and Services
9561
9562A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
9563with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
9564(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
9565
9566@example
9567(define guix-service-type
9568 (service-type
9569 (name 'guix)
9570 (extensions
d4053c71 9571 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
0adfe95a
LC
9572 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
9573 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
9574@end example
8451a568 9575
cf4a9129 9576@noindent
0adfe95a
LC
9577It defines a two things:
9578
9579@enumerate
9580@item
9581A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
9582
9583@item
9584A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
9585target service type and a procedure that, given the service's
9586parameters, returns a list of object to extend the service of that type.
9587
9588Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
9589exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
9590@end enumerate
9591
9592In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
9593
9594@table @var
d4053c71
AK
9595@item shepherd-root-service-type
9596The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
9597service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
9598object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
9599(@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9600
9601@item account-service-type
9602This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
9603which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
9604objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
9605guix-daemon}).
9606
9607@item activation-service-type
9608Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
9609a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
9610booted.
9611@end table
9612
9613A service of this type is instantiated like this:
9614
9615@example
9616(service guix-service-type
9617 (guix-configuration
9618 (build-accounts 5)
9619 (use-substitutes? #f)))
9620@end example
9621
9622The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
9623the parameters of this specific service instance.
9624@xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
9625information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
9626
9627@var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
9628services but is not extensible itself.
9629
9630@c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
9631
9632The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
9633
9634@example
9635(define udev-service-type
9636 (service-type (name 'udev)
9637 (extensions
d4053c71
AK
9638 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
9639 udev-shepherd-service)))
0adfe95a
LC
9640
9641 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
9642 (extend (lambda (config rules)
9643 (match config
9644 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
9645 (udev-configuration
9646 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
9647 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
9648@end example
9649
9650This is the service type for the
9651@uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
9652management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
d4053c71 9653extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
0adfe95a
LC
9654
9655@table @code
9656@item compose
9657This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
9658services of this type.
9659
9660Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
9661compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
9662
9663@item extend
9664This procedure defines how the service's value is @dfn{extended} with
9665the composition of the extensions.
9666
9667Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
9668value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
9669extend that record by appending the list of rules is contains to the
9670list of contributed rules.
9671@end table
9672
9673There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
9674@var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
9675@code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
9676
9677Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
9678interface for services.
9679
9680@node Service Reference
9681@subsubsection Service Reference
9682
9683We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
9684Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
9685services and service types. This interface is provided by the
9686@code{(gnu services)} module.
9687
9688@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
9689Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
9690below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
9691this particular service instance.
9692@end deffn
9693
9694@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
9695Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
9696@end deffn
8451a568 9697
0adfe95a
LC
9698@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
9699Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
9700@end deffn
9701
9702@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
9703Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
9704parameters.
9705@end deffn
9706
9707Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
9708
9709@example
9710(define s
9711 (service nginx-service-type
9712 (nginx-configuration
9713 (nginx nginx)
9714 (log-directory log-directory)
9715 (run-directory run-directory)
9716 (file config-file))))
9717
9718(service? s)
9719@result{} #t
9720
9721(eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
9722@result{} #t
9723@end example
9724
cd6f6c22
LC
9725The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
9726parameters of some of the services of a list such as
9727@var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). Of
9728course, you could always use standard list combinators such as
9729@code{map} and @code{fold} to do that (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,,
9730guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); @code{modify-services} simply
9731provides a more concise form for this common pattern.
9732
9733@deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
9734 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
9735
9736Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
9737clauses. Each clause has the form:
9738
9739@example
9740(@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
9741@end example
9742
9743where @var{type} is a service type, such as @var{guix-service-type}, and
9744@var{variable} is an identifier that is bound within @var{body} to the
9745value of the service of that @var{type}. @xref{Using the Configuration
9746System}, for an example.
9747
9748This is a shorthand for:
9749
9750@example
9751(map (lambda (service) @dots{}) @var{services})
9752@end example
9753@end deffn
9754
9755Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
9756something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
9757necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
9758@code{operating-system} declaration.
9759
0adfe95a
LC
9760@deftp {Data Type} service-type
9761@cindex service type
9762This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
9763and Services}).
9764
9765@table @asis
9766@item @code{name}
9767This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
9768
9769@item @code{extensions}
9770A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below.)
9771
9772@item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
9773If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
9774be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
9775services.
9776
9777Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
9778by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
9779extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
9780the service instance.
9781
9782@item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
9783If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
9784
9785Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9786calls it, passing it the service's initial value as the first argument
9787and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
9788second argument.
9789@end table
9790
9791@xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
9792@end deftp
9793
9794@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
9795 @var{compute}
9796Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
9797@var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9798calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
9799the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
9800@end deffn
9801
9802@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
9803Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
9804@end deffn
9805
9806At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
9807procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
d62e201c
LC
9808down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
9809run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
9810command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
9811service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
9812on the way, until it reaches the root node.
0adfe95a
LC
9813
9814@deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
d62e201c 9815 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
0adfe95a
LC
9816Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
9817type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
9818@end deffn
9819
9820Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
9821service types, some of which are listed below.
9822
d62e201c
LC
9823@defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
9824This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
9825as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
9826@end defvr
9827
0adfe95a 9828@defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
d62e201c
LC
9829The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
9830The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
0adfe95a
LC
9831@end defvr
9832
9833@defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
9834The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
9835passing it name/file tuples such as:
9836
9837@example
9838(list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
9839@end example
9840
9841In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
9842pointing to the given file.
9843@end defvr
9844
9845@defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
9846Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
9847executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
9848setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
9849@end defvr
9850
af4c3fd5
LC
9851@defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
9852Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
9853programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
9854extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
9855@end defvr
9856
0adfe95a 9857
dd17bc38
AK
9858@node Shepherd Services
9859@subsubsection Shepherd Services
0adfe95a
LC
9860
9861@cindex PID 1
9862@cindex init system
0190c1c0
AK
9863The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} provides a way to define services
9864managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is GuixSD initialization
9865system---the first process that is started when the system boots,
9866aka. PID@tie{}1 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
9867Manual}).
6f305ea5 9868
dd17bc38
AK
9869Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
9870SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
9871started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
9872been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
9873the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
6f305ea5 9874
710fa231 9875@image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
6f305ea5
LC
9876
9877You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
710fa231
AK
9878definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
9879(@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
6f305ea5 9880
d4053c71
AK
9881The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
9882PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
9883by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
0adfe95a 9884
d4053c71 9885@deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
dd17bc38 9886The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
0adfe95a
LC
9887
9888@table @asis
9889@item @code{provision}
9890This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
9891
dd17bc38
AK
9892These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
9893@command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
9894shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
9895@code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
0adfe95a
LC
9896
9897@item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
dd17bc38 9898List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
0adfe95a
LC
9899
9900@item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
9901Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
9902underlying process dies.
9903
9904@item @code{start}
9905@itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
dd17bc38
AK
9906The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
9907facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
9908Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
9909G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
9910(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
0adfe95a
LC
9911
9912@item @code{documentation}
9913A documentation string, as shown when running:
9914
9915@example
dd17bc38 9916herd doc @var{service-name}
0adfe95a
LC
9917@end example
9918
9919where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
dd17bc38 9920(@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
fae685b9
LC
9921
9922@item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
9923This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
9924@code{stop} are evaluated.
9925
9926@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @var{%default-imported-modules})
9927This is the list of modules to import in the execution environment of
dd17bc38 9928the Shepherd.
fae685b9 9929
0adfe95a
LC
9930@end table
9931@end deftp
9932
d4053c71 9933@defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
dd17bc38 9934The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
0adfe95a
LC
9935
9936This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
dd17bc38 9937shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
d4053c71 9938Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
0adfe95a
LC
9939@end defvr
9940
d4053c71 9941@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
0adfe95a
LC
9942This service represents PID@tie{}1.
9943@end defvr
8451a568 9944
8451a568 9945
cf4a9129
LC
9946@node Installing Debugging Files
9947@section Installing Debugging Files
8451a568 9948
cf4a9129
LC
9949@cindex debugging files
9950Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
9951typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
9952@dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
9953debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
9954debug a compiled program in good conditions.
8451a568 9955
cf4a9129
LC
9956The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
9957of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
9958weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
9959debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
9960Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
9961debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
9962for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
8451a568 9963
cf4a9129
LC
9964Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
9965mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
9966information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
9967files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
9968when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
9969with GDB}).
8451a568 9970
cf4a9129
LC
9971The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
9972information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
9973output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
9974Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
9975of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
9976installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
9977Guile:
8451a568
LC
9978
9979@example
cf4a9129 9980guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
8451a568
LC
9981@end example
9982
cf4a9129
LC
9983GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
9984setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
9985from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
9986GDB}):
8451a568 9987
cf4a9129
LC
9988@example
9989(gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
9990@end example
8451a568 9991
cf4a9129
LC
9992From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
9993@code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
8451a568 9994
cf4a9129
LC
9995In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
9996code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
9997code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
9998--source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
9999directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
10000@code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
8451a568 10001
cf4a9129
LC
10002@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
10003The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
10004@code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
10005opt-in---debugging information is available only for those packages
10006whose definition explicitly declares a @code{debug} output. This may be
10007changed to opt-out in the future, if our build farm servers can handle
10008the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
10009@command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
8451a568 10010
8451a568 10011
05962f29
LC
10012@node Security Updates
10013@section Security Updates
10014
843858b8
LC
10015@quotation Note
10016As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described in this section is
10017experimental.
10018@end quotation
05962f29
LC
10019
10020@cindex security updates
10021Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in core
10022software packages and must be patched. Guix follows a functional
10023package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
10024that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
10025must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
10026fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
10027distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
10028(@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
10029desired.
10030
10031@cindex grafts
10032To address that, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
10033for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
10034with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
10035package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
10036explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
10037the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
10038order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
10039
10040@cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
10041For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
10042Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
10043Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
10044Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
10045@code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
10046
10047@example
10048(define bash
10049 (package
10050 (name "bash")
10051 ;; @dots{}
10052 (replacement bash-fixed)))
10053@end example
10054
10055From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash that
10056is installed will automatically be ``rewritten'' to refer to
10057@var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
10058time proportional to the size of the package, but expect less than a
10059minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine.
10060
10061Currently, the graft and the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and
10062@var{bash} in the example above) must have the exact same @code{name}
10063and @code{version} fields. This restriction mostly comes from the fact
10064that grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
10065Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
10066package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
10067replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
10068
10069
cf4a9129
LC
10070@node Package Modules
10071@section Package Modules
8451a568 10072
cf4a9129
LC
10073From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
10074GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
10075@dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
10076packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
10077packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
10078naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
10079as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
10080define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
10081Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
10082module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
10083@code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
113daf62 10084
300868ba 10085The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
cf4a9129
LC
10086automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
10087instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
10088packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
10089object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
10090facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
113daf62 10091
300868ba 10092@cindex customization, of packages
8689901f 10093@cindex package module search path
cf4a9129 10094Users can store package definitions in modules with different
60142854 10095names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
c95ded7e
LC
10096name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
10097emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
10098relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
10099@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
10100guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
300868ba
LC
10101will not be visible by default. Thus, users can invoke commands such as
10102@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} have to be used with the
c95ded7e
LC
10103@code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
10104yet, they can use the
300868ba 10105@code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
8689901f
LC
10106(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
10107@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
10108variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
10109honored by all the user interfaces.
10110
10111@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
10112This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for package
10113modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence over the
10114distribution's own modules.
10115@end defvr
ef5dd60a 10116
cf4a9129
LC
10117The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
10118each package is built based solely on other packages in the
10119distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
10120@dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
10121bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
081145cf 10122@pxref{Bootstrapping}.
ef5dd60a 10123
cf4a9129
LC
10124@node Packaging Guidelines
10125@section Packaging Guidelines
ef5dd60a 10126
cf4a9129
LC
10127The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
10128packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
10129grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
10130help.
ef5dd60a 10131
cf4a9129
LC
10132Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
10133@dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
10134all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
10135essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
10136build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
10137it, and adding @dfn{package meta-data} along with that recipe, such as a
10138description and licensing information.
ef5dd60a 10139
cf4a9129
LC
10140In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
10141Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
10142written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
10143for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
10144and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10145However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
10146creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
081145cf 10147@pxref{Defining Packages}.
ef5dd60a 10148
cf4a9129
LC
10149Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
10150source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
10151(@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
c71979f4
LC
10152called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
10153(@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
ef5dd60a
LC
10154
10155@example
cf4a9129 10156./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
ef5dd60a 10157@end example
ef5dd60a 10158
cf4a9129
LC
10159Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
10160it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
10161command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
10162build log.
ef5dd60a 10163
cf4a9129
LC
10164If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
10165the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
10166clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
10167the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
ef5dd60a 10168
cf4a9129
LC
10169@example
10170./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
10171@end example
ef5dd60a 10172
cf4a9129
LC
10173Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
10174(@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
10175help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
10176new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
2b1cee21 10177@url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
cf4a9129 10178system}.
ef5dd60a 10179
cf4a9129
LC
10180@cindex substituter
10181Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
10182@command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
10183@code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
10184package automatically downloads binaries from there
10185(@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
10186needed is to review and apply the patch.
ef5dd60a 10187
ef5dd60a 10188
cf4a9129 10189@menu
ec0339cd
LC
10190* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
10191* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
10192* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 10193* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
10194* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
10195* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
10196* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
cf4a9129 10197@end menu
ef5dd60a 10198
cf4a9129
LC
10199@node Software Freedom
10200@subsection Software Freedom
ef5dd60a 10201
cf4a9129 10202@c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
c11a6eb1 10203
cf4a9129
LC
10204The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
10205freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
10206users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
10207essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
10208in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
10209modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
10210software that conveys these four freedoms.
c11a6eb1 10211
cf4a9129
LC
10212In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
10213@url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
10214software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
10215reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
10216discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
ef5dd60a 10217
cf4a9129
LC
10218Some packages contain a small and optional subset that violates the
10219above guidelines, for instance because this subset is itself non-free
10220code. When that happens, the offending items are removed with
10221appropriate patches or code snippets in the package definition's
10222@code{origin} form (@pxref{Defining Packages}). That way, @code{guix
10223build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
10224upstream source.
ef5dd60a 10225
ef5dd60a 10226
cf4a9129
LC
10227@node Package Naming
10228@subsection Package Naming
ef5dd60a 10229
cf4a9129
LC
10230A package has actually two names associated with it:
10231First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
10232@code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
10233Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
10234the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
10235is used by package management commands such as
10236@command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
ef5dd60a 10237
cf4a9129
LC
10238Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
10239the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
10240hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
10241SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
927097ef 10242
cf4a9129 10243We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
081145cf 10244already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
cf4a9129
LC
10245Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
10246the Python and Perl languages.
927097ef 10247
1b366ee4 10248Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
7fec52b7 10249
ef5dd60a 10250
cf4a9129
LC
10251@node Version Numbers
10252@subsection Version Numbers
ef5dd60a 10253
cf4a9129
LC
10254We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
10255project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
10256two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
10257different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
10258in @ref{Package Naming}
10259for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
10260by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
10261distinguish the two versions.
ef5dd60a 10262
cf4a9129
LC
10263The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
10264package and does not contain any version number.
ef5dd60a 10265
cf4a9129 10266For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
ef5dd60a 10267
cf4a9129
LC
10268@example
10269(define-public gtk+
10270 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10271 (name "gtk+")
10272 (version "3.9.12")
10273 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10274(define-public gtk+-2
10275 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10276 (name "gtk+")
10277 (version "2.24.20")
10278 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10279@end example
10280If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
10281@example
10282(define-public gtk+-3.8
10283 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10284 (name "gtk+")
10285 (version "3.8.2")
10286 ...))
cf4a9129 10287@end example
ef5dd60a 10288
880d647d
LC
10289@c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
10290@c for a discussion of what follows.
10291@cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
10292Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
10293(VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
10294because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
10295release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
10296the @code{version} field?
10297
10298Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
10299visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
10300version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
10301--upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
10302identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
10303a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
10304snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
10305
10306@example
103072.0.11-3.cabba9e
10308 ^ ^ ^
10309 | | `-- upstream commit ID
10310 | |
10311 | `--- Guix package revision
10312 |
10313latest upstream version
10314@end example
10315
10316It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
10317field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
10318aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
10319limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
10320kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
10321@code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities.
10322
cbd02397
LC
10323@node Synopses and Descriptions
10324@subsection Synopses and Descriptions
10325
10326As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
10327synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
10328descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
10329--search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
10330determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
10331packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
10332
10333Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
10334period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
10335not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
10336tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
10337is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
10338used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
10339matching a pattern''.
10340
10341Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
10342audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
10343might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
10344fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
10345is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
10346application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
10347something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
10348hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
10349looking for.
10350
10351@cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
10352Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
10353sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
10354Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
10355ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
ba7d6c76
ML
10356hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
10357should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
10358curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
10359(@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
10360such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
10361appropriately.
cbd02397
LC
10362
10363Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
10364@uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
10365Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
10366their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
10367the language specified by the current locale.
10368
10369Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
10370attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
ba7d6c76 10371additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
36743e71 10372to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
ba7d6c76
ML
10373special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
10374Gettext}):
10375
10376@example
10377;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
10378(description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
10379for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
10380@end example
cbd02397 10381
ef5dd60a 10382
cf4a9129
LC
10383@node Python Modules
10384@subsection Python Modules
ef5dd60a 10385
cf4a9129
LC
10386We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
10387@code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
10388To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
10389seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
10390the word @code{python}.
ef5dd60a 10391
cf4a9129
LC
10392Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
10393If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
10394@code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
10395@code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
10396packages with the corresponding names.
ef5dd60a 10397
cf4a9129
LC
10398If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
10399for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
10400@code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}.
113daf62 10401
523e4896 10402
cf4a9129
LC
10403@node Perl Modules
10404@subsection Perl Modules
523e4896 10405
cf4a9129
LC
10406Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
10407using the lowercase upstream name.
10408For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
10409replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
10410@code{perl-}.
10411So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
10412Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
10413are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
10414@code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
10415prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
523e4896 10416
523e4896 10417
7fec52b7
AE
10418@node Fonts
10419@subsection Fonts
10420
10421For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
10422purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
10423we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
10424applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
10425are part of TeX Live.
10426
10427To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
10428containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
10429upstream package name.
10430
10431The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
10432@code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
10433if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
10434replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
10435to lower case).
10436For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
10437@code{font-sil-gentium}.
10438
10439For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
10440is used in the place of the font family name.
10441For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
10442Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
10443These could be packaged separately under the names
10444@code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
10445under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
10446@code{font-liberation}.
10447
10448In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
10449are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
10450is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
1b366ee4 10451@code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
7fec52b7
AE
10452fonts.
10453
10454
b25937e3 10455
cf4a9129
LC
10456@node Bootstrapping
10457@section Bootstrapping
b25937e3 10458
cf4a9129 10459@c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
b25937e3 10460
cf4a9129 10461@cindex bootstrapping
7889394e 10462
cf4a9129
LC
10463Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
10464``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
10465contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
10466there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
10467get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
10468a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
10469user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
10470a ``regular user''.
72b9d60d 10471
cf4a9129
LC
10472@cindex bootstrap binaries
10473The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
10474GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
10475command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
10476`grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
10477@code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
10478(@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
10479all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
10480Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
10481@dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
72b9d60d 10482
cf4a9129
LC
10483These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
10484re-create them if needed (more on that later).
72b9d60d 10485
cf4a9129 10486@unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
c79d54fe 10487
cf4a9129
LC
10488@c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
10489@c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
10490@image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
523e4896 10491
cf4a9129
LC
10492The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
10493distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
d33fa0c7
LC
10494packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
10495@command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
10496
10497@example
10498guix graph -t derivation \
10499 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
10500 | dot -Tps > t.ps
10501@end example
10502
10503At this level of detail, things are
cf4a9129
LC
10504slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
10505along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
10506loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
10507tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
10508distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
10509(@pxref{The Store}).
2e7b5cea 10510
cf4a9129
LC
10511But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
10512to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
10513derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
10514builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
10515@code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
10516@file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
10517the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
10518tarball to be unpacked.
fb729425 10519
cf4a9129
LC
10520Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
10521Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
10522is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
10523is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
10524@code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
10525@code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
10526in the store, using the original layout. The
10527@code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
10528write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
10529corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
10530@code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
fb729425 10531
cf4a9129
LC
10532Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
10533derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
10534etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
fb729425 10535
fb729425 10536
cf4a9129 10537@unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
523e4896 10538
cf4a9129
LC
10539Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
10540depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
10541no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
10542the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
10543directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
10544``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
1f6f57df 10545the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
df2ce343 10546
d33fa0c7
LC
10547The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
10548the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
10549individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
10550several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
10551one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
10552package from source. The command:
10553
10554@example
10555guix graph -t bag \
10556 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
10557 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
10558@end example
10559
10560@noindent
10561produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
10562library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
10563suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
10564approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
10565
10566@image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
10567
cf4a9129
LC
10568@c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
10569The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
d33fa0c7
LC
10570GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
10571for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
10572built.
523e4896 10573
cf4a9129
LC
10574Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
10575tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
10576used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
10577guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
4af2447e 10578
d33fa0c7
LC
10579From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
10580GCC uses @code{ld}
cf4a9129
LC
10581from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
10582This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
10583the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
4af2447e 10584
cf4a9129
LC
10585And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
10586the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
dd164244
MW
10587variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
10588implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
1f6f57df 10589(@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4af2447e 10590
4af2447e 10591
cf4a9129 10592@unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
4af2447e 10593
cf4a9129
LC
10594Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
10595those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
10596automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
10597the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
4af2447e 10598
cf4a9129
LC
10599The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
10600binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
10601of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
4b2615e1 10602
cf4a9129
LC
10603@example
10604guix build bootstrap-tarballs
10605@end example
10606
10607The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
10608@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
10609this section.
10610
10611Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
10612reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
10613unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
10614significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
10615know.
10616
10617@node Porting
10618@section Porting to a New Platform
10619
10620As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
10621self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
10622binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
10623operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
10624interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
10625not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
10626the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
10627
10628Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
10629When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
10630target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
10631one:
10632
10633@example
10634guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
10635@end example
10636
1c0c417d
LC
10637For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
10638@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
10639file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
10640@code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
10641taught about the new platform.
10642
cf4a9129 10643Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
1c0c417d
LC
10644to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
10645is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
10646must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
10647bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
10648available locally, and @file{gnu-system.am} has rules do download it for
10649the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
10650as well.
cf4a9129
LC
10651
10652In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
10653extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
10654above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
10655recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
10656configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
10657Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
10658platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
10659reason.
4af2447e 10660
9bf3c1a7 10661@c *********************************************************************
8c01b9d0 10662@include contributing.texi
c78bd12b 10663
568717fd
LC
10664@c *********************************************************************
10665@node Acknowledgments
10666@chapter Acknowledgments
10667
136787cb
LC
10668Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
10669which was designed and
4c7ac9aa
LC
10670implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
10671the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
568717fd
LC
10672management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
10673package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
10674transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
10675
10676The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
10677an inspiration for Guix.
10678
4c7ac9aa
LC
10679GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
10680number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
10681information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
10682who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
10683providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
10684
10685
568717fd
LC
10686@c *********************************************************************
10687@node GNU Free Documentation License
10688@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
10689
10690@include fdl-1.3.texi
10691
10692@c *********************************************************************
10693@node Concept Index
10694@unnumbered Concept Index
10695@printindex cp
10696
a85b83d2
LC
10697@node Programming Index
10698@unnumbered Programming Index
10699@syncodeindex tp fn
10700@syncodeindex vr fn
568717fd
LC
10701@printindex fn
10702
10703@bye
10704
10705@c Local Variables:
10706@c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
10707@c End: